2010-12-29 Michael Snyder <msnyder@vmware.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986, 1987, 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
4 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007,
5 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6
7 This file is part of GDB.
8
9 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
12 (at your option) any later version.
13
14 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
21
22 #include "defs.h"
23 #include "arch-utils.h"
24 #include <ctype.h>
25 #include "hashtab.h"
26 #include "symtab.h"
27 #include "frame.h"
28 #include "breakpoint.h"
29 #include "tracepoint.h"
30 #include "gdbtypes.h"
31 #include "expression.h"
32 #include "gdbcore.h"
33 #include "gdbcmd.h"
34 #include "value.h"
35 #include "command.h"
36 #include "inferior.h"
37 #include "gdbthread.h"
38 #include "target.h"
39 #include "language.h"
40 #include "gdb_string.h"
41 #include "demangle.h"
42 #include "annotate.h"
43 #include "symfile.h"
44 #include "objfiles.h"
45 #include "source.h"
46 #include "linespec.h"
47 #include "completer.h"
48 #include "gdb.h"
49 #include "ui-out.h"
50 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
51 #include "gdb_assert.h"
52 #include "block.h"
53 #include "solib.h"
54 #include "solist.h"
55 #include "observer.h"
56 #include "exceptions.h"
57 #include "memattr.h"
58 #include "ada-lang.h"
59 #include "top.h"
60 #include "wrapper.h"
61 #include "valprint.h"
62 #include "jit.h"
63 #include "xml-syscall.h"
64 #include "parser-defs.h"
65
66 /* readline include files */
67 #include "readline/readline.h"
68 #include "readline/history.h"
69
70 /* readline defines this. */
71 #undef savestring
72
73 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
74
75 /* Arguments to pass as context to some catch command handlers. */
76 #define CATCH_PERMANENT ((void *) (uintptr_t) 0)
77 #define CATCH_TEMPORARY ((void *) (uintptr_t) 1)
78
79 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
80
81 static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
82
83 static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
84
85 static void disable_command (char *, int);
86
87 static void enable_command (char *, int);
88
89 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
90 void *),
91 void *);
92
93 static void ignore_command (char *, int);
94
95 static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
96
97 static void clear_command (char *, int);
98
99 static void catch_command (char *, int);
100
101 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
102
103 static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
104
105 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
106
107 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
108 static. */
109 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
110 struct symtab_and_line,
111 enum bptype);
112
113 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
114
115 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
116 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
117 enum bptype bptype);
118
119 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
120 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
121 struct obj_section *, int);
122
123 static int breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1,
124 CORE_ADDR addr1,
125 struct address_space *aspace2,
126 CORE_ADDR addr2);
127
128 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
129 struct bp_location *loc2);
130
131 static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
132
133 static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
134
135 static int breakpoint_1 (int, int, int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
136
137 static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
138
139 static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
140
141 static void commands_command (char *, int);
142
143 static void condition_command (char *, int);
144
145 static int get_number_trailer (char **, int);
146
147 typedef enum
148 {
149 mark_inserted,
150 mark_uninserted
151 }
152 insertion_state_t;
153
154 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
155 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
156
157 static enum print_stop_action print_it_typical (bpstat);
158
159 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
160
161 static int watchpoint_check (void *);
162
163 static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
164
165 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
166
167 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype, int *);
168
169 static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
170
171 static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
172
173 static void do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp);
174
175 static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
176
177 static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
178
179 static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
180
181 static char *ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg);
182
183 static void catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event,
184 char *arg, int tempflag, int from_tty);
185
186 static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
187
188 static void ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s);
189
190 static void detach_single_step_breakpoints (void);
191
192 static int single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *,
193 CORE_ADDR pc);
194
195 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
196 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
197 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
198
199 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
200
201 static void update_global_location_list (int);
202
203 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (int);
204
205 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
206
207 static int is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
208
209 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
210
211 static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
212
213 static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
214
215 static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
216
217 static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
218
219 static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
220
221 static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
222
223 /* Assuming we're creating a static tracepoint, does S look like a
224 static tracepoint marker spec ("-m MARKER_ID")? */
225 #define is_marker_spec(s) \
226 (s != NULL && strncmp (s, "-m", 2) == 0 && ((s)[2] == ' ' || (s)[2] == '\t'))
227
228 /* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
229 breakpoints share a single command list. */
230 struct counted_command_line
231 {
232 /* The reference count. */
233 int refc;
234
235 /* The command list. */
236 struct command_line *commands;
237 };
238
239 struct command_line *
240 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
241 {
242 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
243 }
244
245 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
246 current breakpoint. */
247
248 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
249
250 static const char *
251 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
252 {
253 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
254 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
255 a breakpoint. */
256 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
257
258 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
259 }
260
261 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
262 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
263 if such is available. */
264 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
265
266 static void
267 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
268 struct cmd_list_element *c,
269 const char *value)
270 {
271 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
272 Debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
273 value);
274 }
275
276 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
277 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
278 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
279 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
280 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
281 static void
282 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
283 struct cmd_list_element *c,
284 const char *value)
285 {
286 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
287 Debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
288 value);
289 }
290
291 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
292 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
293 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
294 use hardware breakpoints. */
295 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
296 static void
297 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
298 struct cmd_list_element *c,
299 const char *value)
300 {
301 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
302 Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
303 value);
304 }
305
306 /* If on, gdb will keep breakpoints inserted even as inferior is
307 stopped, and immediately insert any new breakpoints. If off, gdb
308 will insert breakpoints into inferior only when resuming it, and
309 will remove breakpoints upon stop. If auto, GDB will behave as ON
310 if in non-stop mode, and as OFF if all-stop mode.*/
311
312 static const char always_inserted_auto[] = "auto";
313 static const char always_inserted_on[] = "on";
314 static const char always_inserted_off[] = "off";
315 static const char *always_inserted_enums[] = {
316 always_inserted_auto,
317 always_inserted_off,
318 always_inserted_on,
319 NULL
320 };
321 static const char *always_inserted_mode = always_inserted_auto;
322 static void
323 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
324 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
325 {
326 if (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto)
327 fprintf_filtered (file, _("\
328 Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
329 value,
330 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () ? "on" : "off");
331 else
332 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), value);
333 }
334
335 int
336 breakpoints_always_inserted_mode (void)
337 {
338 return (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_on
339 || (always_inserted_mode == always_inserted_auto && non_stop));
340 }
341
342 void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
343
344 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
345 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
346
347 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
348 static int overlay_events_enabled;
349
350 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
351 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statment deletes the
352 current breakpoint. */
353
354 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
355
356 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
357 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
358 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
359 B = TMP)
360
361 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
362 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
363 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
364
365 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
366 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
367 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
368 BP_TMP++)
369
370 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
371
372 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
373 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
374 if (is_tracepoint (B))
375
376 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
377
378 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
379
380 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
381
382 static struct bp_location **bp_location;
383
384 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
385
386 static unsigned bp_location_count;
387
388 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
389 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
390 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
391 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
392 an address you need to read. */
393
394 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
395
396 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
397 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
398 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
399 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
400 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
401
402 static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
403
404 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
405 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
406 by a target. */
407 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
408
409 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
410
411 static int breakpoint_count;
412
413 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
414 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
415 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
416 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
417 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
418
419 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
420
421 static int tracepoint_count;
422
423 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
424 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
425 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
426
427 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
428 static int
429 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
430 {
431 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
432 }
433
434 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
435
436 static void
437 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
438 {
439 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
440 breakpoint_count = num;
441 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
442 }
443
444 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
445 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
446 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
447
448 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
449 breakpoint made. */
450
451 void
452 start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
453 {
454 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
455 }
456
457 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
458 breakpoint made. */
459
460 void
461 end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
462 {
463 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
464 }
465
466 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
467
468 void
469 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
470 {
471 struct breakpoint *b;
472
473 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
474 b->hit_count = 0;
475 }
476
477 /* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
478 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
479
480 static struct counted_command_line *
481 alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
482 {
483 struct counted_command_line *result
484 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
485
486 result->refc = 1;
487 result->commands = commands;
488 return result;
489 }
490
491 /* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
492
493 static void
494 incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
495 {
496 if (cmd)
497 ++cmd->refc;
498 }
499
500 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
501 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
502 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
503
504 static void
505 decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
506 {
507 if (*cmdp)
508 {
509 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
510 {
511 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
512 xfree (*cmdp);
513 }
514 *cmdp = NULL;
515 }
516 }
517
518 /* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
519
520 static void
521 do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
522 {
523 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
524 }
525
526 /* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
527 argument. */
528
529 static struct cleanup *
530 make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
531 {
532 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
533 }
534
535 /* Default address, symtab and line to put a breakpoint at
536 for "break" command with no arg.
537 If default_breakpoint_valid is zero, the other three are
538 not valid, and "break" with no arg is an error.
539
540 This set by print_stack_frame, which calls set_default_breakpoint. */
541
542 int default_breakpoint_valid;
543 CORE_ADDR default_breakpoint_address;
544 struct symtab *default_breakpoint_symtab;
545 int default_breakpoint_line;
546 struct program_space *default_breakpoint_pspace;
547
548 \f
549 /* *PP is a string denoting a breakpoint. Get the number of the
550 breakpoint. Advance *PP after the string and any trailing
551 whitespace.
552
553 Currently the string can either be a number or "$" followed by the
554 name of a convenience variable. Making it an expression wouldn't
555 work well for map_breakpoint_numbers (e.g. "4 + 5 + 6").
556
557 If the string is a NULL pointer, that denotes the last breakpoint.
558
559 TRAILER is a character which can be found after the number; most
560 commonly this is `-'. If you don't want a trailer, use \0. */
561
562 static int
563 get_number_trailer (char **pp, int trailer)
564 {
565 int retval = 0; /* default */
566 char *p = *pp;
567
568 if (p == NULL)
569 /* Empty line means refer to the last breakpoint. */
570 return breakpoint_count;
571 else if (*p == '$')
572 {
573 /* Make a copy of the name, so we can null-terminate it
574 to pass to lookup_internalvar(). */
575 char *varname;
576 char *start = ++p;
577 LONGEST val;
578
579 while (isalnum (*p) || *p == '_')
580 p++;
581 varname = (char *) alloca (p - start + 1);
582 strncpy (varname, start, p - start);
583 varname[p - start] = '\0';
584 if (get_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar (varname), &val))
585 retval = (int) val;
586 else
587 {
588 printf_filtered (_("Convenience variable must have integer value.\n"));
589 retval = 0;
590 }
591 }
592 else
593 {
594 if (*p == '-')
595 ++p;
596 while (*p >= '0' && *p <= '9')
597 ++p;
598 if (p == *pp)
599 /* There is no number here. (e.g. "cond a == b"). */
600 {
601 /* Skip non-numeric token. */
602 while (*p && !isspace((int) *p))
603 ++p;
604 /* Return zero, which caller must interpret as error. */
605 retval = 0;
606 }
607 else
608 retval = atoi (*pp);
609 }
610 if (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
611 {
612 /* Trailing junk: return 0 and let caller print error msg. */
613 while (!(isspace (*p) || *p == '\0' || *p == trailer))
614 ++p;
615 retval = 0;
616 }
617 while (isspace (*p))
618 p++;
619 *pp = p;
620 return retval;
621 }
622
623
624 /* Like get_number_trailer, but don't allow a trailer. */
625 int
626 get_number (char **pp)
627 {
628 return get_number_trailer (pp, '\0');
629 }
630
631 /* Parse a number or a range.
632 A number will be of the form handled by get_number.
633 A range will be of the form <number1> - <number2>, and
634 will represent all the integers between number1 and number2,
635 inclusive.
636
637 While processing a range, this fuction is called iteratively;
638 At each call it will return the next value in the range.
639
640 At the beginning of parsing a range, the char pointer PP will
641 be advanced past <number1> and left pointing at the '-' token.
642 Subsequent calls will not advance the pointer until the range
643 is completed. The call that completes the range will advance
644 pointer PP past <number2>. */
645
646 int
647 get_number_or_range (char **pp)
648 {
649 static int last_retval, end_value;
650 static char *end_ptr;
651 static int in_range = 0;
652
653 if (**pp != '-')
654 {
655 /* Default case: pp is pointing either to a solo number,
656 or to the first number of a range. */
657 last_retval = get_number_trailer (pp, '-');
658 if (**pp == '-')
659 {
660 char **temp;
661
662 /* This is the start of a range (<number1> - <number2>).
663 Skip the '-', parse and remember the second number,
664 and also remember the end of the final token. */
665
666 temp = &end_ptr;
667 end_ptr = *pp + 1;
668 while (isspace ((int) *end_ptr))
669 end_ptr++; /* skip white space */
670 end_value = get_number (temp);
671 if (end_value < last_retval)
672 {
673 error (_("inverted range"));
674 }
675 else if (end_value == last_retval)
676 {
677 /* Degenerate range (number1 == number2). Advance the
678 token pointer so that the range will be treated as a
679 single number. */
680 *pp = end_ptr;
681 }
682 else
683 in_range = 1;
684 }
685 }
686 else if (! in_range)
687 error (_("negative value"));
688 else
689 {
690 /* pp points to the '-' that betokens a range. All
691 number-parsing has already been done. Return the next
692 integer value (one greater than the saved previous value).
693 Do not advance the token pointer 'pp' until the end of range
694 is reached. */
695
696 if (++last_retval == end_value)
697 {
698 /* End of range reached; advance token pointer. */
699 *pp = end_ptr;
700 in_range = 0;
701 }
702 }
703 return last_retval;
704 }
705
706 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
707 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
708
709 struct breakpoint *
710 get_breakpoint (int num)
711 {
712 struct breakpoint *b;
713
714 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
715 if (b->number == num)
716 return b;
717
718 return NULL;
719 }
720
721 \f
722
723 void
724 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
725 int from_tty)
726 {
727 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
728
729 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
730 {
731 xfree (loc->cond);
732 loc->cond = NULL;
733 }
734 xfree (b->cond_string);
735 b->cond_string = NULL;
736 xfree (b->cond_exp);
737 b->cond_exp = NULL;
738
739 if (*exp == 0)
740 {
741 if (from_tty)
742 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
743 }
744 else
745 {
746 char *arg = exp;
747
748 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
749 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
750 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
751 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
752
753 if (is_watchpoint (b))
754 {
755 innermost_block = NULL;
756 arg = exp;
757 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
758 if (*arg)
759 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
760 b->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
761 }
762 else
763 {
764 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
765 {
766 arg = exp;
767 loc->cond =
768 parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
769 if (*arg)
770 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
771 }
772 }
773 }
774 breakpoints_changed ();
775 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
776 }
777
778 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
779
780 static void
781 condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
782 {
783 struct breakpoint *b;
784 char *p;
785 int bnum;
786
787 if (arg == 0)
788 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
789
790 p = arg;
791 bnum = get_number (&p);
792 if (bnum == 0)
793 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
794
795 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
796 if (b->number == bnum)
797 {
798 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
799 return;
800 }
801
802 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
803 }
804
805 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
806 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
807 Throw if any such commands is found. */
808
809 static void
810 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
811 {
812 struct command_line *c;
813
814 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
815 {
816 int i;
817
818 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
819 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
820
821 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
822 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
823
824 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
825 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
826 command directly. */
827 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
828 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
829
830 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
831 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
832 }
833 }
834
835 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
836
837 int
838 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
839 {
840 return (b->type == bp_tracepoint
841 || b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
842 || b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
843 }
844
845 /* A helper function that validsates that COMMANDS are valid for a
846 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
847 found. */
848
849 static void
850 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
851 struct command_line *commands)
852 {
853 if (is_tracepoint (b))
854 {
855 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
856 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
857 while-stepping element, and that while-stepping's body has
858 valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. */
859 struct command_line *c;
860 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
861 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
862 {
863 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
864 {
865 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
866 error (_("\
867 The 'while-stepping' command cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
868 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
869 error (_("\
870 The 'while-stepping' command cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
871
872 if (while_stepping)
873 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can be used only once"));
874 else
875 while_stepping = c;
876 }
877 }
878 if (while_stepping)
879 {
880 struct command_line *c2;
881
882 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
883 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
884 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
885 {
886 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
887 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
888 }
889 }
890 }
891 else
892 {
893 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
894 }
895 }
896
897 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
898 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
899
900 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
901 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
902 {
903 struct breakpoint *b;
904 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
905 struct bp_location *loc;
906
907 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
908 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
909 {
910 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
911 if (loc->address == addr)
912 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
913 }
914
915 return found;
916 }
917
918 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
919 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
920
921 void
922 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
923 struct command_line *commands)
924 {
925 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
926
927 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
928 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
929 breakpoints_changed ();
930 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
931 }
932
933 void
934 check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
935 {
936 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
937
938 validate_actionline (&line, b);
939 }
940
941 /* A structure used to pass information through
942 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
943
944 struct commands_info
945 {
946 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
947 int from_tty;
948
949 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
950 char *arg;
951
952 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
953 already-parsed command. */
954 struct command_line *control;
955
956 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
957 yet been read. */
958 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
959 };
960
961 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
962 commands_command. */
963
964 static void
965 do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
966 {
967 struct commands_info *info = data;
968
969 if (info->cmd == NULL)
970 {
971 struct command_line *l;
972
973 if (info->control != NULL)
974 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
975 else
976 {
977 struct cleanup *old_chain;
978 char *str;
979
980 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) %s, one per line."),
981 info->arg);
982
983 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
984
985 l = read_command_lines (str,
986 info->from_tty, 1,
987 (is_tracepoint (b)
988 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
989 b);
990
991 do_cleanups (old_chain);
992 }
993
994 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
995 }
996
997 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
998 do anything. */
999 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1000 {
1001 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1002 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1003 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1004 b->commands = info->cmd;
1005 breakpoints_changed ();
1006 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
1007 }
1008 }
1009
1010 static void
1011 commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1012 struct command_line *control)
1013 {
1014 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1015 struct commands_info info;
1016
1017 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1018 info.control = control;
1019 info.cmd = NULL;
1020 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1021 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1022 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1023
1024 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1025 {
1026 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1027 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1028 breakpoint_count);
1029 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1030 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1031 else
1032 {
1033 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1034 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1035 numbers will fail in this case. */
1036 arg = NULL;
1037 }
1038 }
1039 else
1040 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1041 our argument. */
1042 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1043
1044 if (arg != NULL)
1045 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1046
1047 info.arg = arg;
1048
1049 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1050
1051 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1052 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1053
1054 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1055 }
1056
1057 static void
1058 commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1059 {
1060 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1061 }
1062
1063 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1064 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1065
1066 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1067 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1068 enum command_control_type
1069 commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1070 {
1071 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1072 return simple_control;
1073 }
1074
1075 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1076
1077 static int
1078 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1079 {
1080 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1081 return 0;
1082 if (!bl->inserted)
1083 return 0;
1084 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1085 /* bp isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1086 return 0;
1087 return 1;
1088 }
1089
1090 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1091 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1092
1093 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1094 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1095 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1096 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1097 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1098 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1099 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1100 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1101 and:
1102 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1103
1104 void
1105 breakpoint_restore_shadows (gdb_byte *buf, ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1106 {
1107 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1108 search. */
1109 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1110
1111 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1112 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1113 report higher one. */
1114
1115 bc_l = 0;
1116 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1117 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1118 {
1119 struct bp_location *bl;
1120
1121 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1122 bl = bp_location[bc];
1123
1124 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1125 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1126 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1127 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1128
1129 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1130 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1131 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1132
1133 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1134 >= bl->address)
1135 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1136 <= memaddr))
1137 bc_l = bc;
1138 else
1139 bc_r = bc;
1140 }
1141
1142 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1143 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1144 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1145 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1146 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1147 B:
1148
1149 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1150
1151 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1152 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1153 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1154 and L2. */
1155 while (bc_l > 0
1156 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1157 bc_l--;
1158
1159 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1160
1161 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1162 {
1163 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1164 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1165 int bp_size = 0;
1166 int bptoffset = 0;
1167
1168 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1169 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1170 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1171 bl->owner->number);
1172
1173 /* Performance optimization: any futher element can no longer affect BUF
1174 content. */
1175
1176 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1177 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1178 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1179 break;
1180
1181 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1182 continue;
1183 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->target_info.placed_address_space, 0,
1184 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1185 continue;
1186
1187 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1188 we need to copy. */
1189 bp_addr = bl->target_info.placed_address;
1190 bp_size = bl->target_info.shadow_len;
1191
1192 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1193 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we
1194 are reading. */
1195 continue;
1196
1197 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1198 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1199 reading. */
1200 continue;
1201
1202 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1203 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1204 {
1205 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1206 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1207 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1208 bp_addr = memaddr;
1209 }
1210
1211 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1212 {
1213 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1214 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1215 }
1216
1217 memcpy (buf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1218 bl->target_info.shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1219 }
1220 }
1221 \f
1222
1223 /* A wrapper function for inserting catchpoints. */
1224 static void
1225 insert_catchpoint (struct ui_out *uo, void *args)
1226 {
1227 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) args;
1228
1229 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
1230 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->insert != NULL);
1231
1232 b->ops->insert (b);
1233 }
1234
1235 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1236
1237 static int
1238 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1239 {
1240 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1241 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1242 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1243 }
1244
1245 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1246 software. */
1247
1248 static int
1249 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1250 {
1251 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1252 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1253 }
1254
1255 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: returns true if the current thread
1256 and its running state are safe to evaluate or update watchpoint B.
1257 Watchpoints on local expressions need to be evaluated in the
1258 context of the thread that was current when the watchpoint was
1259 created, and, that thread needs to be stopped to be able to select
1260 the correct frame context. Watchpoints on global expressions can
1261 be evaluated on any thread, and in any state. It is presently left
1262 to the target allowing memory accesses when threads are
1263 running. */
1264
1265 static int
1266 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct breakpoint *b)
1267 {
1268 return (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1269 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1270 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid)));
1271 }
1272
1273 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1274 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1275 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1276 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1277 in b->loc->cond.
1278 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1279
1280 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1281 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1282 it.
1283
1284 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1285 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1286 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1287 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1288 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1289 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1290 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1291 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1292
1293 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1294 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1295 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1296 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1297 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1298 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1299 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1300 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1301 not changed.
1302
1303 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1304 hardware watchpoints:
1305
1306 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1307 called several times when GDB stops.
1308
1309 [linux]
1310 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1311 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1312 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1313 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1314 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1315 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1316 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1317 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1318 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1319 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1320 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1321
1322 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1323 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1324
1325 static void
1326 update_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, int reparse)
1327 {
1328 int within_current_scope;
1329 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1330 int frame_saved;
1331
1332 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1333 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1334 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1335 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1336 return;
1337
1338 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in bp_location array
1339 and update_global_locations will eventually delete them and
1340 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1341 b->loc = NULL;
1342
1343 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1344 return;
1345
1346 frame_saved = 0;
1347
1348 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1349 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1350 within_current_scope = 1;
1351 else
1352 {
1353 struct frame_info *fi;
1354
1355 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1356 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1357 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1358 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1359 selected frame. */
1360 frame_saved = 1;
1361 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1362
1363 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1364 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1365 if (within_current_scope)
1366 select_frame (fi);
1367 }
1368
1369 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1370 {
1371 char *s;
1372
1373 if (b->exp)
1374 {
1375 xfree (b->exp);
1376 b->exp = NULL;
1377 }
1378 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1379 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1380 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1381 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1382 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1383 be completely different objects. */
1384 value_free (b->val);
1385 b->val = NULL;
1386 b->val_valid = 0;
1387
1388 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1389 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1390 locations (re)created below. */
1391 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1392 {
1393 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1394 {
1395 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1396 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1397 }
1398
1399 s = b->cond_string;
1400 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1401 }
1402 }
1403
1404 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1405 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1406 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1407 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1408 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1409 if ( !target_has_execution)
1410 {
1411 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1412 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1413 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1414 }
1415 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1416 {
1417 int pc = 0;
1418 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1419 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1420
1421 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain);
1422
1423 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1424 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1425 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1426 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. */
1427 if (!b->val_valid)
1428 {
1429 b->val = v;
1430 b->val_valid = 1;
1431 }
1432
1433 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1434 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1435 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1436 is started. */
1437 if ((b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
1438 && reparse)
1439 {
1440 int i, mem_cnt, other_type_used;
1441
1442 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1443 used for all other hardware watchpoints to see if we
1444 still have enough resources to also fit this watchpoint
1445 in as well. To avoid the hw_watchpoint_used_count call
1446 below from counting this watchpoint, make sure that it
1447 is marked as a software watchpoint. */
1448 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1449 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_hardware_watchpoint,
1450 &other_type_used);
1451 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1452
1453 if (!mem_cnt)
1454 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1455 else
1456 {
1457 int target_resources_ok = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint
1458 (bp_hardware_watchpoint, i + mem_cnt, other_type_used);
1459 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1460 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1461 else
1462 b->type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1463 }
1464 }
1465
1466 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1467
1468 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1469 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
1470 {
1471 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1472 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1473 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1474 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1475 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1476 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1477 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1478 {
1479 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1480
1481 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1482 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1483 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1484 if (v == result
1485 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1486 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1487 {
1488 CORE_ADDR addr;
1489 int len, type;
1490 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1491
1492 addr = value_address (v);
1493 len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1494 type = hw_write;
1495 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1496 type = hw_read;
1497 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1498 type = hw_access;
1499
1500 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1501 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1502 ;
1503 *tmp = loc;
1504 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1505
1506 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1507 loc->address = addr;
1508 loc->length = len;
1509 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1510 }
1511 }
1512
1513 next = value_next (v);
1514 if (v != b->val)
1515 value_free (v);
1516 }
1517
1518 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1519 above left it without any location set up. But,
1520 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1521 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1522 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1523 {
1524 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1525 b->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1526 b->loc->address = -1;
1527 b->loc->length = -1;
1528 b->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
1529 }
1530 }
1531 else if (!within_current_scope)
1532 {
1533 printf_filtered (_("\
1534 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1535 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1536 b->number);
1537 if (b->related_breakpoint)
1538 {
1539 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1540 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
1541 b->related_breakpoint= NULL;
1542 }
1543 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1544 }
1545
1546 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1547 if (frame_saved)
1548 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1549 }
1550
1551
1552 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1553 inserted in the inferior. */
1554 static int
1555 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1556 {
1557 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
1558 return 0;
1559
1560 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1561 return 0;
1562
1563 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
1564 return 0;
1565
1566 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
1567 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
1568 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
1569 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
1570 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
1571 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
1572 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
1573 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
1574 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
1575 return 0;
1576
1577 /* Tracepoints are inserted by the target at a time of its choosing,
1578 not by us. */
1579 if (is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
1580 return 0;
1581
1582 return 1;
1583 }
1584
1585 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
1586 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
1587 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
1588
1589 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
1590 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
1591 static int
1592 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
1593 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
1594 int *disabled_breaks,
1595 int *hw_breakpoint_error)
1596 {
1597 int val = 0;
1598
1599 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
1600 return 0;
1601
1602 /* Initialize the target-specific information. */
1603 memset (&bl->target_info, 0, sizeof (bl->target_info));
1604 bl->target_info.placed_address = bl->address;
1605 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
1606
1607 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1608 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1609 {
1610 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
1611 {
1612 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
1613 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
1614 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
1615
1616 Two important cases are:
1617 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
1618 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
1619 hardware breakpoint.
1620 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
1621 read-write. This means we've previously made the
1622 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
1623 so we undo.
1624
1625 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
1626 location types we've just set here, the only possible
1627 problem is that memory map has changed during running
1628 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
1629 gdb. */
1630 struct mem_region *mr
1631 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.placed_address);
1632
1633 if (mr)
1634 {
1635 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
1636 {
1637 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
1638
1639 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1640 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
1641 else
1642 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
1643
1644 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
1645 {
1646 static int said = 0;
1647
1648 bl->loc_type = new_type;
1649 if (!said)
1650 {
1651 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout, _("\
1652 Note: automatically using hardware breakpoints for read-only addresses.\n"));
1653 said = 1;
1654 }
1655 }
1656 }
1657 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
1658 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
1659 warning (_("cannot set software breakpoint at readonly address %s"),
1660 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
1661 }
1662 }
1663
1664 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
1665 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
1666 || bl->section == NULL
1667 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
1668 {
1669 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
1670
1671 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1672 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1673 &bl->target_info);
1674 else
1675 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1676 &bl->target_info);
1677 }
1678 else
1679 {
1680 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
1681 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
1682 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
1683 {
1684 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
1685 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
1686 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
1687 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1688 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
1689 bl->owner->number);
1690 else
1691 {
1692 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
1693 bl->section);
1694 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
1695 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
1696 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
1697 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1698 &bl->overlay_target_info);
1699 if (val != 0)
1700 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1701 "Overlay breakpoint %d failed: in ROM?\n",
1702 bl->owner->number);
1703 }
1704 }
1705 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
1706 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
1707 {
1708 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
1709 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1710 val = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1711 &bl->target_info);
1712 else
1713 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
1714 &bl->target_info);
1715 }
1716 else
1717 {
1718 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
1719 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
1720 return 0;
1721 }
1722 }
1723
1724 if (val)
1725 {
1726 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
1727 if (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
1728 {
1729 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
1730 val = 0;
1731 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
1732 if (!*disabled_breaks)
1733 {
1734 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1735 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1736 bl->owner->number);
1737 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1738 "Temporarily disabling shared library breakpoints:\n");
1739 }
1740 *disabled_breaks = 1;
1741 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1742 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
1743 }
1744 else
1745 {
1746 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
1747 {
1748 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1749 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1750 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d.\n",
1751 bl->owner->number);
1752 }
1753 else
1754 {
1755 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1756 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
1757 bl->owner->number);
1758 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream,
1759 "Error accessing memory address ");
1760 fputs_filtered (paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
1761 tmp_error_stream);
1762 fprintf_filtered (tmp_error_stream, ": %s.\n",
1763 safe_strerror (val));
1764 }
1765
1766 }
1767 }
1768 else
1769 bl->inserted = 1;
1770
1771 return val;
1772 }
1773
1774 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
1775 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
1776 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
1777 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
1778 {
1779 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address,
1780 bl->length,
1781 bl->watchpoint_type,
1782 bl->owner->cond_exp);
1783
1784 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
1785 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
1786 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
1787 {
1788 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1789
1790 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
1791 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
1792 of this one. */
1793 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1794 if (loc != bl
1795 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
1796 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
1797 {
1798 bl->duplicate = 1;
1799 bl->inserted = 1;
1800 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
1801 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1802 val = 0;
1803 break;
1804 }
1805
1806 if (val == 1)
1807 {
1808 val = target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address,
1809 bl->length,
1810 hw_access,
1811 bl->owner->cond_exp);
1812 if (val == 0)
1813 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
1814 }
1815 }
1816
1817 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
1818 }
1819
1820 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
1821 {
1822 struct gdb_exception e = catch_exception (uiout, insert_catchpoint,
1823 bl->owner, RETURN_MASK_ERROR);
1824 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, "warning: inserting catchpoint %d: ",
1825 bl->owner->number);
1826 if (e.reason < 0)
1827 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
1828 else
1829 bl->inserted = 1;
1830
1831 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
1832 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
1833 so just return success. */
1834 return 0;
1835 }
1836
1837 return 0;
1838 }
1839
1840 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
1841 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
1842 PSPACE anymore. */
1843
1844 void
1845 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
1846 {
1847 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
1848 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
1849
1850 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
1851 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
1852 {
1853 if (b->pspace == pspace)
1854 delete_breakpoint (b);
1855 }
1856
1857 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
1858 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
1859 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
1860 {
1861 struct bp_location *tmp;
1862
1863 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
1864 {
1865 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1866 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
1867 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
1868 else
1869 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
1870 if (tmp->next == loc)
1871 {
1872 tmp->next = loc->next;
1873 break;
1874 }
1875 }
1876 }
1877
1878 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
1879 removed locations above. */
1880 update_global_location_list (0);
1881 }
1882
1883 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
1884 Throws exception on any error.
1885 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
1886 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
1887 void
1888 insert_breakpoints (void)
1889 {
1890 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1891
1892 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1893 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1894 update_watchpoint (bpt, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
1895
1896 update_global_location_list (1);
1897
1898 /* update_global_location_list does not insert breakpoints when
1899 always_inserted_mode is not enabled. Explicitly insert them
1900 now. */
1901 if (!breakpoints_always_inserted_mode ())
1902 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
1903 }
1904
1905 /* insert_breakpoints is used when starting or continuing the program.
1906 remove_breakpoints is used when the program stops.
1907 Both return zero if successful,
1908 or an `errno' value if could not write the inferior. */
1909
1910 static void
1911 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
1912 {
1913 struct breakpoint *bpt;
1914 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
1915 int error = 0;
1916 int val = 0;
1917 int disabled_breaks = 0;
1918 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
1919
1920 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
1921 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
1922
1923 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
1924 there was an error. */
1925 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
1926
1927 save_current_space_and_thread ();
1928
1929 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
1930 {
1931 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
1932 continue;
1933
1934 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
1935 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
1936 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1937 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
1938 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
1939 continue;
1940
1941 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
1942
1943 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
1944 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
1945 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
1946 insert breakpoints. */
1947 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
1948 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
1949 continue;
1950
1951 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
1952 &hw_breakpoint_error);
1953 if (val)
1954 error = val;
1955 }
1956
1957 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
1958 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
1959 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
1960 {
1961 int some_failed = 0;
1962 struct bp_location *loc;
1963
1964 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
1965 continue;
1966
1967 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
1968 continue;
1969
1970 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1971 continue;
1972
1973 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1974 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
1975 {
1976 some_failed = 1;
1977 break;
1978 }
1979 if (some_failed)
1980 {
1981 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1982 if (loc->inserted)
1983 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
1984
1985 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
1986 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
1987 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
1988 bpt->number);
1989 error = -1;
1990 }
1991 }
1992
1993 if (error)
1994 {
1995 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
1996 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
1997 if (hw_breakpoint_error)
1998 {
1999 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2000 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
2001 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
2002 }
2003 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
2004 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2005 }
2006
2007 do_cleanups (cleanups);
2008 }
2009
2010 int
2011 remove_breakpoints (void)
2012 {
2013 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2014 int val = 0;
2015
2016 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2017 {
2018 if (bl->inserted)
2019 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
2020 }
2021 return val;
2022 }
2023
2024 /* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
2025
2026 int
2027 remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
2028 {
2029 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2030 int val;
2031 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2032
2033 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2034 {
2035 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2036 continue;
2037
2038 if (bl->inserted)
2039 {
2040 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
2041 if (val != 0)
2042 return val;
2043 }
2044 }
2045 return 0;
2046 }
2047
2048 int
2049 remove_hw_watchpoints (void)
2050 {
2051 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2052 int val = 0;
2053
2054 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2055 {
2056 if (bl->inserted && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2057 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
2058 }
2059 return val;
2060 }
2061
2062 int
2063 reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
2064 {
2065 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2066 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2067 int val;
2068 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
2069 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0;
2070 struct inferior *inf;
2071 struct thread_info *tp;
2072
2073 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
2074 if (tp == NULL)
2075 return 1;
2076
2077 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
2078 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2079
2080 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
2081
2082 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
2083
2084 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2085 {
2086 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2087 continue;
2088
2089 if (bl->inserted)
2090 {
2091 bl->inserted = 0;
2092 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2);
2093 if (val != 0)
2094 {
2095 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2096 return val;
2097 }
2098 }
2099 }
2100 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2101 return 0;
2102 }
2103
2104 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
2105
2106 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
2107 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
2108 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
2109 Otherwis the breakpoint number will be populated from
2110 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
2111 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
2112 static void
2113 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
2114 {
2115 if (internal)
2116 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2117 else
2118 {
2119 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
2120 b->number = breakpoint_count;
2121 }
2122 }
2123
2124 static struct breakpoint *
2125 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
2126 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type)
2127 {
2128 struct symtab_and_line sal;
2129 struct breakpoint *b;
2130
2131 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
2132
2133 sal.pc = address;
2134 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
2135 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
2136
2137 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
2138 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
2139 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
2140
2141 return b;
2142 }
2143
2144 static void
2145 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (char *func_name)
2146 {
2147 struct objfile *objfile;
2148
2149 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2150 {
2151 struct breakpoint *b;
2152 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2153
2154 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2155 if (m == NULL)
2156 continue;
2157
2158 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2159 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2160 bp_overlay_event);
2161 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2162
2163 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
2164 {
2165 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
2166 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
2167 }
2168 else
2169 {
2170 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2171 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
2172 }
2173 }
2174 update_global_location_list (1);
2175 }
2176
2177 static void
2178 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (char *func_name)
2179 {
2180 struct program_space *pspace;
2181 struct objfile *objfile;
2182 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2183
2184 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2185
2186 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2187 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2188 {
2189 struct breakpoint *b;
2190 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2191
2192 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (get_objfile_arch (objfile)))
2193 continue;
2194
2195 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2196
2197 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
2198 if (m == NULL)
2199 continue;
2200
2201 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2202 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2203 bp_longjmp_master);
2204 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2205 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2206 }
2207 update_global_location_list (1);
2208
2209 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2210 }
2211
2212 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. The actual function
2213 looked for is named FUNC_NAME. */
2214 static void
2215 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (const char *func_name)
2216 {
2217 struct program_space *pspace;
2218 struct objfile *objfile;
2219 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2220
2221 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
2222
2223 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
2224 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2225 {
2226 struct breakpoint *b;
2227 struct minimal_symbol *m;
2228
2229 set_current_program_space (pspace);
2230
2231 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
2232 if (m == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_text
2233 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m) != mst_file_text))
2234 continue;
2235
2236 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile),
2237 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (m),
2238 bp_std_terminate_master);
2239 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
2240 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2241 }
2242 update_global_location_list (1);
2243
2244 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2245 }
2246
2247 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
2248
2249 void
2250 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
2251 {
2252 struct objfile *objfile;
2253
2254 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
2255 {
2256 struct minimal_symbol *debug_hook;
2257
2258 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol ("_Unwind_DebugHook", NULL, objfile);
2259 if (debug_hook != NULL)
2260 {
2261 struct breakpoint *b;
2262 CORE_ADDR addr = SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (debug_hook);
2263 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
2264
2265 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
2266 &current_target);
2267 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master);
2268 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("_Unwind_DebugHook");
2269 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2270 }
2271 }
2272
2273 update_global_location_list (1);
2274 }
2275
2276 void
2277 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
2278 {
2279 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
2280 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
2281
2282 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
2283 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
2284 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
2285 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
2286 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
2287 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
2288 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
2289 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
2290 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
2291 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
2292 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
2293
2294 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
2295 {
2296 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
2297 continue;
2298
2299 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2300 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
2301 {
2302 delete_breakpoint (b);
2303 continue;
2304 }
2305
2306 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
2307 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
2308 {
2309 delete_breakpoint (b);
2310 continue;
2311 }
2312
2313 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
2314 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
2315 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
2316 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
2317 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
2318 {
2319 delete_breakpoint (b);
2320 continue;
2321 }
2322
2323 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
2324 if (b->type == bp_step_resume)
2325 {
2326 delete_breakpoint (b);
2327 continue;
2328 }
2329
2330 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
2331 after an exec. */
2332 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
2333 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
2334 {
2335 delete_breakpoint (b);
2336 continue;
2337 }
2338
2339 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
2340 {
2341 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
2342 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
2343 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
2344 a new method, and call this method from here. */
2345 continue;
2346 }
2347
2348 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
2349 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
2350 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
2351 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
2352 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
2353 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
2354
2355 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
2356 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
2357 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
2358 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
2359 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
2360 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
2361 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
2362
2363 In the absense of a general solution for the "how do we know
2364 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
2365 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
2366 let finish_command delete it.
2367
2368 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
2369 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
2370 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
2371 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
2372 solib breakpoints.) */
2373
2374 if (b->type == bp_finish)
2375 {
2376 continue;
2377 }
2378
2379 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
2380 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
2381 a.out. */
2382 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
2383 {
2384 delete_breakpoint (b);
2385 continue;
2386 }
2387 }
2388 /* FIXME what about longjmp breakpoints? Re-create them here? */
2389 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
2390 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
2391 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
2392 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
2393 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
2394 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ("std::terminate()");
2395 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
2396 }
2397
2398 int
2399 detach_breakpoints (int pid)
2400 {
2401 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2402 int val = 0;
2403 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
2404 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
2405
2406 if (pid == PIDGET (inferior_ptid))
2407 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
2408
2409 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
2410 inferior_ptid = pid_to_ptid (pid);
2411 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2412 {
2413 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
2414 continue;
2415
2416 if (bl->inserted)
2417 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
2418 }
2419
2420 /* Detach single-step breakpoints as well. */
2421 detach_single_step_breakpoints ();
2422
2423 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2424 return val;
2425 }
2426
2427 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
2428 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
2429 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
2430 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
2431 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
2432
2433 static int
2434 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
2435 {
2436 int val;
2437
2438 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2439 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
2440
2441 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2442 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2443 return 0;
2444
2445 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2446 This should not ever happen. */
2447 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
2448
2449 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2450 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2451 {
2452 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
2453 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
2454 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
2455
2456 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2457 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2458 || bl->section == NULL
2459 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2460 {
2461 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
2462
2463 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2464 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
2465 else
2466 val = target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
2467 }
2468 else
2469 {
2470 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2471 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2472 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2473 {
2474 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
2475 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
2476 */
2477 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
2478 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
2479 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2480 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2481 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2482 else
2483 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2484 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2485 }
2486 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
2487 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
2488 if (bl->inserted)
2489 {
2490 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
2491 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
2492 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
2493 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
2494 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2495 val = target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2496 &bl->target_info);
2497
2498 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
2499 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
2500 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
2501 else if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2502 val = target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2503 &bl->target_info);
2504 else
2505 val = 0;
2506 }
2507 else
2508 {
2509 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
2510 val = 0;
2511 }
2512 }
2513
2514 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint
2515 in a shared library that has already been removed, but we
2516 have not yet processed the shlib unload event. */
2517 if (val && solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address))
2518 val = 0;
2519
2520 if (val)
2521 return val;
2522 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2523 }
2524 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2525 {
2526 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2527 val = target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, bl->length,
2528 bl->watchpoint_type,
2529 bl->owner->cond_exp);
2530
2531 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
2532 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
2533 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
2534 bl->owner->number);
2535 }
2536 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
2537 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2538 && !bl->duplicate)
2539 {
2540 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL && bl->owner->ops->remove != NULL);
2541
2542 val = bl->owner->ops->remove (bl->owner);
2543 if (val)
2544 return val;
2545 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
2546 }
2547
2548 return 0;
2549 }
2550
2551 static int
2552 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
2553 {
2554 int ret;
2555 struct cleanup *old_chain;
2556
2557 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
2558 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
2559
2560 if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2561 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
2562 return 0;
2563
2564 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
2565 This should not ever happen. */
2566 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
2567
2568 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
2569
2570 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2571
2572 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
2573
2574 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2575 return ret;
2576 }
2577
2578 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
2579
2580 void
2581 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
2582 {
2583 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2584
2585 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2586 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
2587 bl->inserted = 0;
2588 }
2589
2590 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
2591 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
2592
2593 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
2594 between runs.
2595
2596 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
2597 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
2598 init_wait_for_inferior). */
2599
2600
2601
2602 void
2603 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
2604 {
2605 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
2606 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2607 int ix;
2608 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
2609
2610 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
2611 nothing to do. */
2612 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))
2613 return;
2614
2615 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2616 {
2617 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2618 if (bl->pspace == pspace
2619 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2620 bl->inserted = 0;
2621 }
2622
2623 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
2624 {
2625 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
2626 continue;
2627
2628 switch (b->type)
2629 {
2630 case bp_call_dummy:
2631
2632 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
2633 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
2634 rid of it. */
2635
2636 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
2637
2638 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
2639
2640 case bp_shlib_event:
2641
2642 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
2643 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
2644 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
2645 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
2646 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
2647
2648 (gdb) file prog-linux
2649 (gdb) run # native linux target
2650 ...
2651 (gdb) kill
2652 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
2653 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
2654 */
2655
2656 delete_breakpoint (b);
2657 break;
2658
2659 case bp_watchpoint:
2660 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
2661 case bp_read_watchpoint:
2662 case bp_access_watchpoint:
2663
2664 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
2665 if (b->exp_valid_block != NULL)
2666 delete_breakpoint (b);
2667 else if (context == inf_starting)
2668 {
2669 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
2670 insert_breakpoints. */
2671 if (b->val)
2672 value_free (b->val);
2673 b->val = NULL;
2674 b->val_valid = 0;
2675 }
2676 break;
2677 default:
2678 break;
2679 }
2680 }
2681
2682 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
2683 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
2684 decref_bp_location (&bl);
2685 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
2686 }
2687
2688 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
2689 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
2690 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
2691 match, not program space. */
2692
2693 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
2694 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
2695 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
2696 permanent breakpoint.
2697 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
2698 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
2699 - When continuing from a localion with a permanent breakpoint, we
2700 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
2701 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
2702
2703 enum breakpoint_here
2704 breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2705 {
2706 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2707 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
2708
2709 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2710 {
2711 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2712 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2713 continue;
2714
2715 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2716 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2717 || bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2718 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2719 aspace, pc))
2720 {
2721 if (overlay_debugging
2722 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2723 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2724 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2725 else if (bl->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent)
2726 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
2727 else
2728 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
2729 }
2730 }
2731
2732 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
2733 }
2734
2735 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
2736
2737 int
2738 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2739 {
2740 struct bp_location *loc;
2741 int ix;
2742
2743 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
2744 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
2745 aspace, pc))
2746 return 1;
2747
2748 return 0;
2749 }
2750
2751 /* Returns non-zero if there's a breakpoint inserted at PC, which is
2752 inserted using regular breakpoint_chain / bp_location array
2753 mechanism. This does not check for single-step breakpoints, which
2754 are inserted and removed using direct target manipulation. */
2755
2756 int
2757 regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
2758 CORE_ADDR pc)
2759 {
2760 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2761
2762 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2763 {
2764 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2765 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2766 continue;
2767
2768 if (bl->inserted
2769 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2770 aspace, pc))
2771 {
2772 if (overlay_debugging
2773 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2774 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2775 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2776 else
2777 return 1;
2778 }
2779 }
2780 return 0;
2781 }
2782
2783 /* Returns non-zero iff there's either regular breakpoint
2784 or a single step breakpoint inserted at PC. */
2785
2786 int
2787 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2788 {
2789 if (regular_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2790 return 1;
2791
2792 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2793 return 1;
2794
2795 return 0;
2796 }
2797
2798 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
2799 inserted at PC. */
2800
2801 int
2802 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
2803 {
2804 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2805
2806 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2807 {
2808 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
2809 continue;
2810
2811 if (bl->inserted
2812 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2813 aspace, pc))
2814 {
2815 if (overlay_debugging
2816 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2817 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2818 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2819 else
2820 return 1;
2821 }
2822 }
2823
2824 /* Also check for software single-step breakpoints. */
2825 if (single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (aspace, pc))
2826 return 1;
2827
2828 return 0;
2829 }
2830
2831 int
2832 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
2833 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
2834 {
2835 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2836
2837 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2838 {
2839 struct bp_location *loc;
2840
2841 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
2842 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
2843 continue;
2844
2845 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2846 continue;
2847
2848 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2849 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
2850 {
2851 CORE_ADDR l, h;
2852
2853 /* Check for intersection. */
2854 l = max (loc->address, addr);
2855 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
2856 if (l < h)
2857 return 1;
2858 }
2859 }
2860 return 0;
2861 }
2862
2863 /* breakpoint_thread_match (PC, PTID) returns true if the breakpoint at
2864 PC is valid for process/thread PTID. */
2865
2866 int
2867 breakpoint_thread_match (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
2868 ptid_t ptid)
2869 {
2870 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2871 /* The thread and task IDs associated to PTID, computed lazily. */
2872 int thread = -1;
2873 int task = 0;
2874
2875 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2876 {
2877 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2878 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2879 continue;
2880
2881 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has bl->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2882 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
2883 && bl->owner->enable_state != bp_permanent)
2884 continue;
2885
2886 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
2887 aspace, pc))
2888 continue;
2889
2890 if (bl->owner->thread != -1)
2891 {
2892 /* This is a thread-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2893 matches that thread. If thread hasn't been computed yet,
2894 it is now time to do so. */
2895 if (thread == -1)
2896 thread = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
2897 if (bl->owner->thread != thread)
2898 continue;
2899 }
2900
2901 if (bl->owner->task != 0)
2902 {
2903 /* This is a task-specific breakpoint. Check that ptid
2904 matches that task. If task hasn't been computed yet,
2905 it is now time to do so. */
2906 if (task == 0)
2907 task = ada_get_task_number (ptid);
2908 if (bl->owner->task != task)
2909 continue;
2910 }
2911
2912 if (overlay_debugging
2913 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
2914 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2915 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
2916
2917 return 1;
2918 }
2919
2920 return 0;
2921 }
2922 \f
2923
2924 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
2925 in breakpoint.h. */
2926
2927 int
2928 ep_is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
2929 {
2930 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
2931 }
2932
2933 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
2934 'next' chain. */
2935
2936 static void
2937 bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
2938 {
2939 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2940 value_free (bs->old_val);
2941 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
2942 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
2943 xfree (bs);
2944 }
2945
2946 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
2947 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
2948
2949 void
2950 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
2951 {
2952 bpstat p;
2953 bpstat q;
2954
2955 if (bsp == 0)
2956 return;
2957 p = *bsp;
2958 while (p != NULL)
2959 {
2960 q = p->next;
2961 bpstat_free (p);
2962 p = q;
2963 }
2964 *bsp = NULL;
2965 }
2966
2967 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
2968 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
2969
2970 bpstat
2971 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
2972 {
2973 bpstat p = NULL;
2974 bpstat tmp;
2975 bpstat retval = NULL;
2976
2977 if (bs == NULL)
2978 return bs;
2979
2980 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
2981 {
2982 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
2983 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
2984 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
2985 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
2986 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
2987 {
2988 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
2989 release_value (tmp->old_val);
2990 }
2991
2992 if (p == NULL)
2993 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
2994 retval = tmp;
2995 else
2996 p->next = tmp;
2997 p = tmp;
2998 }
2999 p->next = NULL;
3000 return retval;
3001 }
3002
3003 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
3004
3005 bpstat
3006 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
3007 {
3008 if (bsp == NULL)
3009 return NULL;
3010
3011 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
3012 {
3013 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
3014 return bsp;
3015 }
3016 return NULL;
3017 }
3018
3019 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
3020 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
3021 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
3022 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
3023
3024 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
3025 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
3026 we set it.
3027 Return 1 otherwise. */
3028
3029 int
3030 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
3031 {
3032 struct breakpoint *b;
3033
3034 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
3035 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
3036
3037 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
3038 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
3039 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
3040 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
3041 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
3042 if (b == NULL)
3043 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
3044
3045 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
3046 return 1;
3047 }
3048
3049 /* Modify BS so that the actions will not be performed. */
3050
3051 void
3052 bpstat_clear_actions (bpstat bs)
3053 {
3054 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3055 {
3056 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
3057 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3058 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3059 {
3060 value_free (bs->old_val);
3061 bs->old_val = NULL;
3062 }
3063 }
3064 }
3065
3066 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
3067
3068 static void
3069 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
3070 {
3071 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3072 {
3073 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
3074
3075 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
3076 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
3077 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
3078 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
3079 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
3080 return;
3081 }
3082
3083 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
3084 }
3085
3086 /* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
3087 command. */
3088 static void
3089 cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
3090 {
3091 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
3092 }
3093
3094 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
3095 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
3096 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
3097 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
3098
3099 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
3100 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
3101 bpstat of the current thread. */
3102
3103 static int
3104 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
3105 {
3106 bpstat bs;
3107 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3108 int again = 0;
3109
3110 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
3111 in bs->commands. */
3112 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
3113 return 0;
3114
3115 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
3116 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
3117
3118 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
3119 bs = *bsp;
3120
3121 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
3122 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
3123 {
3124 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
3125 struct command_line *cmd;
3126 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
3127
3128 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
3129
3130 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
3131 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
3132 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
3133 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
3134 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
3135 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
3136 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
3137 the tree when we're done. */
3138 ccmd = bs->commands;
3139 bs->commands = NULL;
3140 this_cmd_tree_chain
3141 = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
3142 cmd = bs->commands_left;
3143 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3144
3145 while (cmd != NULL)
3146 {
3147 execute_control_command (cmd);
3148
3149 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3150 break;
3151 else
3152 cmd = cmd->next;
3153 }
3154
3155 /* We can free this command tree now. */
3156 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
3157
3158 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
3159 {
3160 if (target_can_async_p ())
3161 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
3162 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
3163 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
3164 ;
3165 else
3166 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
3167 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
3168 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
3169 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
3170 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
3171 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
3172 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
3173 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
3174 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
3175 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
3176 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
3177 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
3178 with the new stop_bpstat. */
3179 again = 1;
3180 break;
3181 }
3182 }
3183 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3184 return again;
3185 }
3186
3187 void
3188 bpstat_do_actions (void)
3189 {
3190 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
3191 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
3192 && target_has_execution
3193 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
3194 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
3195 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
3196 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
3197 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
3198 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
3199 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
3200 break;
3201 }
3202
3203 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
3204
3205 static void
3206 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
3207 {
3208 if (val == NULL)
3209 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
3210 else
3211 {
3212 struct value_print_options opts;
3213 get_user_print_options (&opts);
3214 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
3215 }
3216 }
3217
3218 /* This is the normal print function for a bpstat. In the future,
3219 much of this logic could (should?) be moved to bpstat_stop_status,
3220 by having it set different print_it values.
3221
3222 Current scheme: When we stop, bpstat_print() is called. It loops
3223 through the bpstat list of things causing this stop, calling the
3224 print_bp_stop_message function on each one. The behavior of the
3225 print_bp_stop_message function depends on the print_it field of
3226 bpstat. If such field so indicates, call this function here.
3227
3228 Return values from this routine (ultimately used by bpstat_print()
3229 and normal_stop() to decide what to do):
3230 PRINT_NOTHING: Means we already printed all we needed to print,
3231 don't print anything else.
3232 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, and we do *not* desire
3233 that something to be followed by a location.
3234 PRINT_SCR_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and we *do* desire
3235 that something to be followed by a location.
3236 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing or we need to do some more
3237 analysis. */
3238
3239 static enum print_stop_action
3240 print_it_typical (bpstat bs)
3241 {
3242 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3243 struct breakpoint *b;
3244 const struct bp_location *bl;
3245 struct ui_stream *stb;
3246 int bp_temp = 0;
3247 enum print_stop_action result;
3248
3249 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
3250 which has since been deleted. */
3251 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
3252 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3253
3254 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
3255
3256 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
3257 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3258
3259 stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
3260 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
3261
3262 switch (b->type)
3263 {
3264 case bp_breakpoint:
3265 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
3266 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
3267 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
3268 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
3269 bl->address,
3270 b->number, 1);
3271 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
3272 if (bp_temp)
3273 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
3274 else
3275 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
3276 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3277 {
3278 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
3279 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
3280 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
3281 }
3282 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
3283 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
3284 result = PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3285 break;
3286
3287 case bp_shlib_event:
3288 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
3289 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
3290 to shlib event" message.) */
3291 printf_filtered (_("Stopped due to shared library event\n"));
3292 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3293 break;
3294
3295 case bp_thread_event:
3296 /* Not sure how we will get here.
3297 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
3298 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3299 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3300 break;
3301
3302 case bp_overlay_event:
3303 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
3304 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3305 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3306 break;
3307
3308 case bp_longjmp_master:
3309 /* These should never be enabled. */
3310 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3311 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3312 break;
3313
3314 case bp_std_terminate_master:
3315 /* These should never be enabled. */
3316 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3317 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3318 break;
3319
3320 case bp_exception_master:
3321 /* These should never be enabled. */
3322 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
3323 result = PRINT_NOTHING;
3324 break;
3325
3326 case bp_watchpoint:
3327 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3328 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3329 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3330 ui_out_field_string
3331 (uiout, "reason",
3332 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3333 mention (b);
3334 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3335 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3336 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3337 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3338 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3339 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3340 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3341 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3342 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
3343 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3344 break;
3345
3346 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3347 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3348 ui_out_field_string
3349 (uiout, "reason",
3350 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3351 mention (b);
3352 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3353 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3354 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3355 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
3356 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3357 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3358 break;
3359
3360 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3361 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
3362 {
3363 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
3364 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3365 ui_out_field_string
3366 (uiout, "reason",
3367 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3368 mention (b);
3369 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3370 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
3371 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb->stream);
3372 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
3373 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
3374 }
3375 else
3376 {
3377 mention (b);
3378 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3379 ui_out_field_string
3380 (uiout, "reason",
3381 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
3382 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
3383 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
3384 }
3385 watchpoint_value_print (b->val, stb->stream);
3386 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
3387 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
3388 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3389 break;
3390
3391 /* Fall through, we don't deal with these types of breakpoints
3392 here. */
3393
3394 case bp_finish:
3395 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3396 ui_out_field_string
3397 (uiout, "reason",
3398 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
3399 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3400 break;
3401
3402 case bp_until:
3403 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3404 ui_out_field_string
3405 (uiout, "reason",
3406 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
3407 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3408 break;
3409
3410 case bp_none:
3411 case bp_longjmp:
3412 case bp_longjmp_resume:
3413 case bp_exception:
3414 case bp_exception_resume:
3415 case bp_step_resume:
3416 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3417 case bp_call_dummy:
3418 case bp_std_terminate:
3419 case bp_tracepoint:
3420 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
3421 case bp_jit_event:
3422 default:
3423 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3424 break;
3425 }
3426
3427 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3428 return result;
3429 }
3430
3431 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
3432 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
3433 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
3434 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
3435 normal_stop(). */
3436
3437 static enum print_stop_action
3438 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
3439 {
3440 switch (bs->print_it)
3441 {
3442 case print_it_noop:
3443 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
3444 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3445 break;
3446
3447 case print_it_done:
3448 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
3449 relevant messages. */
3450 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
3451 break;
3452
3453 case print_it_normal:
3454 {
3455 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3456
3457 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method, or
3458 print_it_typical. */
3459 /* FIXME: how breakpoint can ever be NULL here? */
3460 if (b != NULL && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_it != NULL)
3461 return b->ops->print_it (b);
3462 else
3463 return print_it_typical (bs);
3464 }
3465 break;
3466
3467 default:
3468 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
3469 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
3470 break;
3471 }
3472 }
3473
3474 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
3475 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
3476 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. This
3477 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
3478 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
3479 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
3480 routine is one of:
3481
3482 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
3483 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
3484 code to print the location. An example is
3485 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
3486 the location.
3487 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
3488 to also print the location part of the message.
3489 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
3490 don't require a location appended to the end.
3491 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
3492 further info to be printed. */
3493
3494 enum print_stop_action
3495 bpstat_print (bpstat bs)
3496 {
3497 int val;
3498
3499 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
3500 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
3501 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
3502 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
3503 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
3504 {
3505 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
3506 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
3507 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
3508 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
3509 return val;
3510 }
3511
3512 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
3513 with and nothing was printed. */
3514 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
3515 }
3516
3517 /* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero. This is
3518 used inside a catch_errors to evaluate the breakpoint condition.
3519 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
3520 "char *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
3521
3522 static int
3523 breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
3524 {
3525 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3526 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
3527
3528 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3529 return i;
3530 }
3531
3532 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
3533
3534 static bpstat
3535 bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
3536 {
3537 bpstat bs;
3538
3539 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
3540 bs->next = NULL;
3541 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
3542 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
3543 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
3544 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
3545 incref_bp_location (bl);
3546 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
3547 bs->commands = NULL;
3548 bs->commands_left = NULL;
3549 bs->old_val = NULL;
3550 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
3551 return bs;
3552 }
3553 \f
3554 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
3555 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
3556
3557 int
3558 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
3559 {
3560 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
3561 CORE_ADDR addr;
3562 struct breakpoint *b;
3563
3564 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
3565 {
3566 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
3567 as not triggered. */
3568 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3569 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3570 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3571
3572 return 0;
3573 }
3574
3575 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
3576 {
3577 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
3578 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
3579 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3580 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3581 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
3582
3583 return stopped_by_watchpoint;
3584 }
3585
3586 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
3587 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
3588 triggered. */
3589
3590 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
3591 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
3592 {
3593 struct bp_location *loc;
3594
3595 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
3596 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3597 /* Exact match not required. Within range is
3598 sufficient. */
3599 if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
3600 addr, loc->address,
3601 loc->length))
3602 {
3603 b->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
3604 break;
3605 }
3606 }
3607
3608 return 1;
3609 }
3610
3611 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
3612 because of check_errors). */
3613 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
3614 #define WP_DELETED 1
3615 /* The value has changed. */
3616 #define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
3617 /* The value has not changed. */
3618 #define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
3619 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
3620 #define WP_IGNORE 4
3621
3622 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
3623 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
3624
3625 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
3626 changed.
3627
3628 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
3629 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
3630
3631 static int
3632 watchpoint_check (void *p)
3633 {
3634 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
3635 struct breakpoint *b;
3636 struct frame_info *fr;
3637 int within_current_scope;
3638
3639 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
3640 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
3641 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3642
3643 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
3644 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
3645 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
3646 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
3647 return WP_IGNORE;
3648
3649 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
3650 within_current_scope = 1;
3651 else
3652 {
3653 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
3654 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
3655 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
3656
3657 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
3658 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
3659 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
3660 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
3661 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
3662 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
3663 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
3664 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
3665 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
3666 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
3667 return WP_IGNORE;
3668
3669 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
3670 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
3671
3672 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
3673 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
3674 if (within_current_scope)
3675 {
3676 struct symbol *function;
3677
3678 function = get_frame_function (fr);
3679 if (function == NULL
3680 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
3681 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
3682 within_current_scope = 0;
3683 }
3684
3685 if (within_current_scope)
3686 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
3687 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
3688 the user. */
3689 select_frame (fr);
3690 }
3691
3692 if (within_current_scope)
3693 {
3694 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
3695 time before we return to the command level and call
3696 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
3697 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
3698
3699 int pc = 0;
3700 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
3701 struct value *new_val;
3702
3703 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL);
3704
3705 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
3706 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
3707 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
3708 not what we want. */
3709 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
3710 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
3711 {
3712 if (new_val != NULL)
3713 {
3714 release_value (new_val);
3715 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3716 }
3717 bs->old_val = b->val;
3718 b->val = new_val;
3719 b->val_valid = 1;
3720 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
3721 }
3722 else
3723 {
3724 /* Nothing changed. */
3725 value_free_to_mark (mark);
3726 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
3727 }
3728 }
3729 else
3730 {
3731 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
3732 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
3733 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
3734 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
3735 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
3736 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
3737 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
3738 the first value assigned). */
3739 /* We print all the stop information in print_it_typical(), but
3740 in this case, by the time we call print_it_typical() this bp
3741 will be deleted already. So we have no choice but print the
3742 information here. */
3743 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
3744 ui_out_field_string
3745 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
3746 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
3747 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->number);
3748 ui_out_text (uiout, " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
3749 which its expression is valid.\n");
3750
3751 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3752 {
3753 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3754 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3755 b->related_breakpoint = NULL;
3756 }
3757 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3758
3759 return WP_DELETED;
3760 }
3761 }
3762
3763 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
3764 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we
3765 should stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
3766 static int
3767 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
3768 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr)
3769 {
3770 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
3771
3772 /* BL is from existing struct breakpoint. */
3773 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3774
3775 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
3776 tracepoints. */
3777 if (is_tracepoint (b))
3778 return 0;
3779
3780 if (!is_watchpoint (b)
3781 && b->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
3782 && b->type != bp_catchpoint) /* a non-watchpoint bp */
3783 {
3784 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
3785 aspace, bp_addr))
3786 return 0;
3787 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3788 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3789 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3790 return 0;
3791 }
3792
3793 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
3794 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
3795 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
3796 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
3797 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
3798 (did not match the data address). */
3799
3800 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
3801 && b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
3802 return 0;
3803
3804 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
3805 {
3806 if (bl->address != bp_addr)
3807 return 0;
3808 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
3809 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3810 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3811 return 0;
3812 }
3813
3814 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3815 {
3816 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->breakpoint_hit != NULL);
3817 if (!b->ops->breakpoint_hit (b))
3818 return 0;
3819 }
3820
3821 return 1;
3822 }
3823
3824 /* If BS refers to a watchpoint, determine if the watched values
3825 has actually changed, and we should stop. If not, set BS->stop
3826 to 0. */
3827 static void
3828 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
3829 {
3830 const struct bp_location *bl;
3831 struct breakpoint *b;
3832
3833 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3834 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
3835 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
3836 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3837 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3838
3839 if (is_watchpoint (b))
3840 {
3841 int must_check_value = 0;
3842
3843 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3844 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
3845 watched value. */
3846 must_check_value = 1;
3847 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
3848 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
3849 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
3850 this watchpoint. */
3851 must_check_value = 1;
3852 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
3853 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
3854 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
3855 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
3856 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
3857 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
3858 must_check_value = 1;
3859
3860 if (must_check_value)
3861 {
3862 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
3863 b->number);
3864 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
3865 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
3866 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
3867 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3868 switch (e)
3869 {
3870 case WP_DELETED:
3871 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3872 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3873 /* Stop. */
3874 break;
3875 case WP_IGNORE:
3876 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3877 bs->stop = 0;
3878 break;
3879 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
3880 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
3881 {
3882 /* There are two cases to consider here:
3883
3884 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
3885 In that case, trust the target, and always report
3886 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
3887 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
3888 have changed since the last time it was read, and
3889 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
3890 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
3891 old value.
3892
3893 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
3894 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
3895 happen:
3896
3897 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
3898 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
3899 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
3900 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
3901
3902 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
3903 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
3904 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
3905 watchpoint.
3906
3907 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
3908 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
3909 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
3910 changes. This still gives false positives when
3911 the program writes the same value to memory as
3912 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
3913 it for a read), but it's much better than
3914 nothing. */
3915
3916 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
3917
3918 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
3919 {
3920 struct breakpoint *other_b;
3921
3922 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
3923 if ((other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3924 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
3925 && (other_b->watchpoint_triggered
3926 == watch_triggered_yes))
3927 {
3928 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
3929 break;
3930 }
3931 }
3932
3933 if (other_write_watchpoint
3934 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
3935 {
3936 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
3937 and the value changed since the last time we
3938 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
3939 Ignore it. */
3940 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3941 bs->stop = 0;
3942 }
3943 }
3944 break;
3945 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
3946 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
3947 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
3948 {
3949 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
3950 the value hasn't changed. */
3951 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3952 bs->stop = 0;
3953 }
3954 /* Stop. */
3955 break;
3956 default:
3957 /* Can't happen. */
3958 case 0:
3959 /* Error from catch_errors. */
3960 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->number);
3961 if (b->related_breakpoint)
3962 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3963 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3964 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
3965 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
3966 break;
3967 }
3968 }
3969 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
3970 {
3971 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
3972 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
3973 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
3974 anything for this watchpoint. */
3975 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
3976 bs->stop = 0;
3977 }
3978 }
3979 }
3980
3981
3982 /* Check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
3983 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
3984 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
3985
3986 static void
3987 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
3988 {
3989 int thread_id = pid_to_thread_id (ptid);
3990 const struct bp_location *bl;
3991 struct breakpoint *b;
3992
3993 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
3994 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
3995 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
3996 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
3997 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
3998
3999 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
4000 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
4001 bs->stop = 0;
4002 else if (bs->stop)
4003 {
4004 int value_is_zero = 0;
4005 struct expression *cond;
4006
4007 if (is_watchpoint (b))
4008 cond = b->cond_exp;
4009 else
4010 cond = bl->cond;
4011
4012 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
4013 {
4014 int within_current_scope = 1;
4015
4016 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
4017 be a long time before we return to the command level and
4018 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
4019 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
4020 function call. */
4021 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4022
4023 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
4024 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
4025 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
4026 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
4027 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
4028 call site. */
4029 if (!is_watchpoint (b) || b->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
4030 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
4031 else
4032 {
4033 struct frame_info *frame;
4034
4035 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
4036 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
4037 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
4038 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
4039 really matter which instantiation of the function
4040 where the condition makes sense triggers the
4041 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
4042 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
4043 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
4044 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
4045 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
4046 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
4047 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
4048 intuitive. */
4049 frame = block_innermost_frame (b->cond_exp_valid_block);
4050 if (frame != NULL)
4051 select_frame (frame);
4052 else
4053 within_current_scope = 0;
4054 }
4055 if (within_current_scope)
4056 value_is_zero
4057 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
4058 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
4059 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
4060 else
4061 {
4062 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
4063 "in the current scope"));
4064 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
4065 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
4066 value_is_zero = 0;
4067 }
4068 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
4069 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4070 }
4071
4072 if (cond && value_is_zero)
4073 {
4074 bs->stop = 0;
4075 }
4076 else if (b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread_id)
4077 {
4078 bs->stop = 0;
4079 }
4080 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
4081 {
4082 b->ignore_count--;
4083 annotate_ignore_count_change ();
4084 bs->stop = 0;
4085 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
4086 ++(b->hit_count);
4087 }
4088 }
4089 }
4090
4091
4092 /* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
4093 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
4094
4095 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
4096 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
4097 that:
4098
4099 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
4100
4101 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
4102
4103 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
4104 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
4105 several reasons concurrently.)
4106
4107 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
4108 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
4109
4110 bpstat
4111 bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
4112 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid)
4113 {
4114 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
4115 struct bp_location *bl;
4116 struct bp_location *loc;
4117 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
4118 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
4119 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
4120 bpstat bs;
4121 int ix;
4122 int need_remove_insert;
4123 int removed_any;
4124
4125 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
4126 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
4127 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
4128 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
4129 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
4130 inferior function calls. */
4131
4132 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4133 {
4134 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4135 continue;
4136
4137 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
4138 {
4139 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
4140 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
4141 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
4142 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
4143 checked all locations already. */
4144 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
4145 break;
4146
4147 if (bl->shlib_disabled)
4148 continue;
4149
4150 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr))
4151 continue;
4152
4153 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
4154 matches. */
4155
4156 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
4157 explain stop. */
4158
4159 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
4160 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
4161 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
4162 bs->stop = 1;
4163 bs->print = 1;
4164
4165 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
4166 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
4167 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
4168 iteration. */
4169 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
4170 b->related_breakpoint->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4171 }
4172 }
4173
4174 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4175 {
4176 if (breakpoint_address_match (loc->pspace->aspace, loc->address,
4177 aspace, bp_addr))
4178 {
4179 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
4180 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
4181 bs->stop = 0;
4182 bs->print = 0;
4183 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4184 }
4185 }
4186
4187 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
4188 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
4189 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
4190
4191 removed_any = 0;
4192
4193 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4194 {
4195 if (!bs->stop)
4196 continue;
4197
4198 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
4199 if (!bs->stop)
4200 continue;
4201
4202 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4203
4204 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
4205 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master
4206 || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
4207 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
4208 /* We do not stop for these. */
4209 bs->stop = 0;
4210 else
4211 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
4212
4213 if (bs->stop)
4214 {
4215 ++(b->hit_count);
4216
4217 /* We will stop here. */
4218 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
4219 {
4220 if (b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
4221 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
4222 removed_any = 1;
4223 }
4224 if (b->silent)
4225 bs->print = 0;
4226 bs->commands = b->commands;
4227 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
4228 bs->commands_left = bs->commands ? bs->commands->commands : NULL;
4229 if (bs->commands_left
4230 && (strcmp ("silent", bs->commands_left->line) == 0
4231 || (xdb_commands
4232 && strcmp ("Q",
4233 bs->commands_left->line) == 0)))
4234 {
4235 bs->commands_left = bs->commands_left->next;
4236 bs->print = 0;
4237 }
4238 }
4239
4240 /* Print nothing for this entry if we dont stop or dont print. */
4241 if (bs->stop == 0 || bs->print == 0)
4242 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
4243 }
4244
4245 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
4246 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
4247 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
4248 done later. */
4249 need_remove_insert = 0;
4250 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
4251 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4252 if (!bs->stop
4253 && bs->breakpoint_at
4254 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
4255 {
4256 update_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
4257 need_remove_insert = 1;
4258 }
4259
4260 if (need_remove_insert)
4261 update_global_location_list (1);
4262 else if (removed_any)
4263 update_global_location_list (0);
4264
4265 return bs_head;
4266 }
4267
4268 static void
4269 handle_jit_event (void)
4270 {
4271 struct frame_info *frame;
4272 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
4273
4274 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4275 breakpoint_re_set. */
4276 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4277
4278 frame = get_current_frame ();
4279 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4280
4281 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
4282
4283 target_terminal_inferior ();
4284 }
4285
4286 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
4287
4288 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
4289
4290 struct bpstat_what
4291 bpstat_what (bpstat bs)
4292 {
4293 struct bpstat_what retval;
4294 /* We need to defer calling `solib_add', as adding new symbols
4295 resets breakpoints, which in turn deletes breakpoint locations,
4296 and hence may clear unprocessed entries in the BS chain. */
4297 int shlib_event = 0;
4298 int jit_event = 0;
4299
4300 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4301 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
4302 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
4303
4304 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4305 {
4306 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
4307 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
4308 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
4309 enum bptype bptype;
4310
4311 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4312 {
4313 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
4314 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
4315 bptype = bp_none;
4316 }
4317 else if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4318 bptype = bp_none;
4319 else
4320 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
4321
4322 switch (bptype)
4323 {
4324 case bp_none:
4325 break;
4326 case bp_breakpoint:
4327 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4328 case bp_until:
4329 case bp_finish:
4330 if (bs->stop)
4331 {
4332 if (bs->print)
4333 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4334 else
4335 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4336 }
4337 else
4338 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4339 break;
4340 case bp_watchpoint:
4341 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4342 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4343 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4344 if (bs->stop)
4345 {
4346 if (bs->print)
4347 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4348 else
4349 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4350 }
4351 else
4352 {
4353 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4354 This requires no further action. */
4355 }
4356 break;
4357 case bp_longjmp:
4358 case bp_exception:
4359 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4360 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp;
4361 break;
4362 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4363 case bp_exception_resume:
4364 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
4365 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
4366 break;
4367 case bp_step_resume:
4368 if (bs->stop)
4369 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
4370 else
4371 {
4372 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
4373 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4374 }
4375 break;
4376 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4377 case bp_thread_event:
4378 case bp_overlay_event:
4379 case bp_longjmp_master:
4380 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4381 case bp_exception_master:
4382 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4383 break;
4384 case bp_catchpoint:
4385 if (bs->stop)
4386 {
4387 if (bs->print)
4388 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4389 else
4390 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4391 }
4392 else
4393 {
4394 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
4395 This requires no further action. */
4396 }
4397 break;
4398 case bp_shlib_event:
4399 shlib_event = 1;
4400
4401 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB
4402 of events. This allows the user to get control and place
4403 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically
4404 loaded objects (among other things). */
4405 if (stop_on_solib_events)
4406 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
4407 else
4408 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4409 break;
4410 case bp_jit_event:
4411 jit_event = 1;
4412 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
4413 break;
4414 case bp_call_dummy:
4415 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4416 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4417 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
4418 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4419 break;
4420 case bp_std_terminate:
4421 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
4422 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
4423 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
4424 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
4425 break;
4426 case bp_tracepoint:
4427 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4428 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4429 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
4430 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
4431 out already. */
4432 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4433 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
4434 default:
4435 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4436 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
4437 }
4438
4439 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
4440 }
4441
4442 if (shlib_event)
4443 {
4444 if (debug_infrun)
4445 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_shlib_event\n");
4446
4447 /* Check for any newly added shared libraries if we're supposed
4448 to be adding them automatically. */
4449
4450 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
4451 breakpoint_re_set. */
4452 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
4453
4454 #ifdef SOLIB_ADD
4455 SOLIB_ADD (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4456 #else
4457 solib_add (NULL, 0, &current_target, auto_solib_add);
4458 #endif
4459
4460 target_terminal_inferior ();
4461 }
4462
4463 if (jit_event)
4464 {
4465 if (debug_infrun)
4466 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
4467
4468 handle_jit_event ();
4469 }
4470
4471 return retval;
4472 }
4473
4474 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
4475 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
4476 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
4477
4478 int
4479 bpstat_should_step (void)
4480 {
4481 struct breakpoint *b;
4482
4483 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4484 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
4485 return 1;
4486 return 0;
4487 }
4488
4489 int
4490 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
4491 {
4492 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4493 if (bs->stop)
4494 return 1;
4495
4496 return 0;
4497 }
4498
4499 \f
4500
4501 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
4502
4503 static void print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4504 struct bp_location *loc,
4505 char *wrap_indent,
4506 struct ui_stream *stb)
4507 {
4508 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
4509
4510 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
4511 loc = NULL;
4512
4513 if (loc != NULL)
4514 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
4515
4516 if (b->source_file && loc)
4517 {
4518 struct symbol *sym
4519 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
4520 if (sym)
4521 {
4522 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
4523 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
4524 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
4525 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent);
4526 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
4527 }
4528 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", b->source_file);
4529 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
4530
4531 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4532 {
4533 struct symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (loc->address, 0);
4534 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
4535
4536 if (fullname)
4537 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
4538 }
4539
4540 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", b->line_number);
4541 }
4542 else if (loc)
4543 {
4544 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb->stream,
4545 demangle, "");
4546 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
4547 }
4548 else
4549 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
4550
4551 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4552 }
4553
4554 static const char *
4555 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
4556 {
4557 struct ep_type_description
4558 {
4559 enum bptype type;
4560 char *description;
4561 };
4562 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
4563 {
4564 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
4565 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
4566 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
4567 {bp_until, "until"},
4568 {bp_finish, "finish"},
4569 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
4570 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
4571 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
4572 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
4573 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
4574 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
4575 {bp_exception, "exception"},
4576 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
4577 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
4578 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
4579 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
4580 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
4581 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
4582 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
4583 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
4584 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
4585 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
4586 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
4587 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
4588 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
4589 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
4590 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
4591 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
4592 };
4593
4594 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
4595 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
4596 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4597 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
4598 (int) type);
4599
4600 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
4601 }
4602
4603 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
4604
4605 static void
4606 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
4607 struct bp_location *loc,
4608 int loc_number,
4609 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4610 int print_address_bits,
4611 int allflag)
4612 {
4613 struct command_line *l;
4614 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
4615 char wrap_indent[80];
4616 struct ui_stream *stb = ui_out_stream_new (uiout);
4617 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_stream_delete (stb);
4618 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
4619
4620 int header_of_multiple = 0;
4621 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
4622 struct value_print_options opts;
4623
4624 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4625
4626 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
4627 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
4628 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
4629 if (loc == NULL
4630 && (b->loc != NULL
4631 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
4632 header_of_multiple = 1;
4633 if (loc == NULL)
4634 loc = b->loc;
4635
4636 annotate_record ();
4637 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
4638
4639 /* 1 */
4640 annotate_field (0);
4641 if (part_of_multiple)
4642 {
4643 char *formatted;
4644 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
4645 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
4646 xfree (formatted);
4647 }
4648 else
4649 {
4650 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
4651 }
4652
4653 /* 2 */
4654 annotate_field (1);
4655 if (part_of_multiple)
4656 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
4657 else
4658 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
4659
4660 /* 3 */
4661 annotate_field (2);
4662 if (part_of_multiple)
4663 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
4664 else
4665 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
4666
4667
4668 /* 4 */
4669 annotate_field (3);
4670 if (part_of_multiple)
4671 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
4672 else
4673 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
4674 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
4675 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
4676
4677
4678 /* 5 and 6 */
4679 strcpy (wrap_indent, " ");
4680 if (opts.addressprint)
4681 {
4682 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
4683 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4684 else
4685 strcat (wrap_indent, " ");
4686 }
4687
4688 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
4689 {
4690 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
4691 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
4692 make sure there's just one location. */
4693 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
4694 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
4695 }
4696 else
4697 switch (b->type)
4698 {
4699 case bp_none:
4700 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4701 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
4702 break;
4703
4704 case bp_watchpoint:
4705 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4706 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4707 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4708 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
4709 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
4710 is relatively readable). */
4711 if (opts.addressprint)
4712 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
4713 annotate_field (5);
4714 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exp_string);
4715 break;
4716
4717 case bp_breakpoint:
4718 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
4719 case bp_until:
4720 case bp_finish:
4721 case bp_longjmp:
4722 case bp_longjmp_resume:
4723 case bp_exception:
4724 case bp_exception_resume:
4725 case bp_step_resume:
4726 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4727 case bp_call_dummy:
4728 case bp_std_terminate:
4729 case bp_shlib_event:
4730 case bp_thread_event:
4731 case bp_overlay_event:
4732 case bp_longjmp_master:
4733 case bp_std_terminate_master:
4734 case bp_exception_master:
4735 case bp_tracepoint:
4736 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
4737 case bp_static_tracepoint:
4738 case bp_jit_event:
4739 if (opts.addressprint)
4740 {
4741 annotate_field (4);
4742 if (header_of_multiple)
4743 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
4744 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
4745 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
4746 else
4747 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
4748 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
4749 }
4750 annotate_field (5);
4751 if (!header_of_multiple)
4752 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc, wrap_indent, stb);
4753 if (b->loc)
4754 *last_loc = b->loc;
4755 break;
4756 }
4757
4758
4759 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors unless there
4760 are several. */
4761 if (loc != NULL
4762 && !header_of_multiple
4763 && (allflag
4764 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
4765 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
4766 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
4767 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
4768 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
4769 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)))
4770 {
4771 struct inferior *inf;
4772 int first = 1;
4773
4774 for (inf = inferior_list; inf != NULL; inf = inf->next)
4775 {
4776 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
4777 {
4778 if (first)
4779 {
4780 first = 0;
4781 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
4782 }
4783 else
4784 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
4785 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf->num));
4786 }
4787 }
4788 }
4789
4790 if (!part_of_multiple)
4791 {
4792 if (b->thread != -1)
4793 {
4794 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
4795 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
4796 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
4797 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4798 }
4799 else if (b->task != 0)
4800 {
4801 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
4802 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
4803 }
4804 }
4805
4806 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4807
4808 if (!part_of_multiple && b->static_trace_marker_id)
4809 {
4810 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
4811
4812 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
4813 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
4814 b->static_trace_marker_id);
4815 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4816 }
4817
4818 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
4819 {
4820 annotate_field (6);
4821 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
4822 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poeking around inside
4823 the frame ID. */
4824 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
4825 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
4826 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4827 }
4828
4829 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string && !ada_exception_catchpoint_p (b))
4830 {
4831 /* We do not print the condition for Ada exception catchpoints
4832 because the condition is an internal implementation detail
4833 that we do not want to expose to the user. */
4834 annotate_field (7);
4835 if (is_tracepoint (b))
4836 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
4837 else
4838 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
4839 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
4840 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4841 }
4842
4843 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
4844 {
4845 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
4846 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
4847 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
4848 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
4849 }
4850
4851 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count)
4852 {
4853 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
4854 if (ep_is_catchpoint (b))
4855 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
4856 else
4857 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
4858 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
4859 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4860 if (b->hit_count == 1)
4861 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
4862 else
4863 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
4864 }
4865
4866 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi.
4867 FIXME: Should have a better test for this. */
4868 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4869 if (!part_of_multiple && b->hit_count == 0)
4870 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
4871
4872 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
4873 {
4874 annotate_field (8);
4875 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
4876 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
4877 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
4878 }
4879
4880 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
4881 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
4882 {
4883 struct cleanup *script_chain;
4884
4885 annotate_field (9);
4886 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
4887 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
4888 do_cleanups (script_chain);
4889 }
4890
4891 if (!part_of_multiple && b->pass_count)
4892 {
4893 annotate_field (10);
4894 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
4895 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", b->pass_count);
4896 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
4897 }
4898
4899 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
4900 {
4901 if (b->addr_string)
4902 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
4903 else if (b->exp_string)
4904 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->exp_string);
4905 }
4906
4907 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
4908 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4909 }
4910
4911 static void
4912 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
4913 struct bp_location **last_loc,
4914 int print_address_bits,
4915 int allflag)
4916 {
4917 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc,
4918 print_address_bits, allflag);
4919
4920 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
4921 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
4922 locations, if any. */
4923 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
4924 {
4925 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
4926 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
4927 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
4928 situation.
4929
4930 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
4931 internally, that's no a property exposed to user. */
4932 if (b->loc
4933 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
4934 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled)
4935 && !ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
4936 {
4937 struct bp_location *loc;
4938 int n = 1;
4939 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
4940 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
4941 print_address_bits, allflag);
4942 }
4943 }
4944 }
4945
4946 static int
4947 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
4948 {
4949 int print_address_bits = 0;
4950 struct bp_location *loc;
4951
4952 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4953 {
4954 int addr_bit;
4955
4956 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
4957 an address to print. */
4958 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
4959 continue;
4960
4961 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
4962 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
4963 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
4964 }
4965
4966 return print_address_bits;
4967 }
4968
4969 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
4970 {
4971 int bnum;
4972 };
4973
4974 static int
4975 do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
4976 {
4977 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
4978 struct breakpoint *b;
4979 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
4980
4981 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4982 {
4983 if (args->bnum == b->number)
4984 {
4985 int print_address_bits = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
4986
4987 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, print_address_bits, 0);
4988 return GDB_RC_OK;
4989 }
4990 }
4991 return GDB_RC_NONE;
4992 }
4993
4994 enum gdb_rc
4995 gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
4996 char **error_message)
4997 {
4998 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
4999
5000 args.bnum = bnum;
5001 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
5002 an error. */
5003 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
5004 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
5005 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
5006 else
5007 return GDB_RC_OK;
5008 }
5009
5010 /* Return non-zero if B is user settable (breakpoints, watchpoints,
5011 catchpoints, et.al.). */
5012
5013 static int
5014 user_settable_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
5015 {
5016 return (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5017 || b->type == bp_catchpoint
5018 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5019 || is_tracepoint (b)
5020 || is_watchpoint (b));
5021 }
5022
5023 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
5024 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
5025 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
5026 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
5027 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
5028 breakpoints listed. */
5029
5030 static int
5031 breakpoint_1 (int bnum, int allflag,
5032 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
5033 {
5034 struct breakpoint *b;
5035 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
5036 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
5037 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
5038 struct value_print_options opts;
5039 int print_address_bits = 0;
5040 int print_type_col_width = 14;
5041
5042 get_user_print_options (&opts);
5043
5044 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
5045 required for address fields. */
5046 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
5047 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5048 if (bnum == -1
5049 || bnum == b->number)
5050 {
5051 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
5052 if (filter && !filter (b))
5053 continue;
5054
5055 if (allflag || (user_settable_breakpoint (b)
5056 && b->number > 0))
5057 {
5058 int addr_bit, type_len;
5059
5060 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
5061 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
5062 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
5063
5064 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
5065 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
5066 print_type_col_width = type_len;
5067
5068 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
5069 }
5070 }
5071
5072 if (opts.addressprint)
5073 bkpttbl_chain
5074 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6, nr_printable_breakpoints,
5075 "BreakpointTable");
5076 else
5077 bkpttbl_chain
5078 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5, nr_printable_breakpoints,
5079 "BreakpointTable");
5080
5081 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5082 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
5083 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5084 annotate_field (0);
5085 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
5086 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5087 annotate_field (1);
5088 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
5089 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
5090 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5091 annotate_field (2);
5092 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
5093 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5094 annotate_field (3);
5095 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
5096 if (opts.addressprint)
5097 {
5098 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5099 annotate_field (4);
5100 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
5101 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
5102 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
5103 else
5104 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
5105 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
5106 }
5107 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5108 annotate_field (5);
5109 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
5110 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
5111 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
5112 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
5113
5114 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5115 {
5116 QUIT;
5117 if (bnum == -1
5118 || bnum == b->number)
5119 {
5120 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
5121 if (filter && !filter (b))
5122 continue;
5123
5124 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
5125 allflag is set. */
5126 if (allflag || (user_settable_breakpoint (b)
5127 && b->number > 0))
5128 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, print_address_bits, allflag);
5129 }
5130 }
5131
5132 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
5133
5134 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
5135 {
5136 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
5137 empty list. */
5138 if (!filter)
5139 {
5140 if (bnum == -1)
5141 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
5142 else
5143 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
5144 "No breakpoint or watchpoint number %d.\n",
5145 bnum);
5146 }
5147 }
5148 else
5149 {
5150 if (last_loc && !server_command)
5151 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
5152 }
5153
5154 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
5155 there have been breakpoints? */
5156 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
5157
5158 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
5159 }
5160
5161 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
5162 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
5163
5164 static void
5165 default_collect_info (void)
5166 {
5167 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
5168 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
5169 not wanted. */
5170 if (!*default_collect)
5171 return;
5172
5173 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
5174 actions. */
5175 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
5176 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
5177 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
5178 }
5179
5180 static void
5181 breakpoints_info (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
5182 {
5183 int bnum = -1;
5184
5185 if (bnum_exp)
5186 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
5187
5188 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 0, NULL);
5189
5190 default_collect_info ();
5191 }
5192
5193 static void
5194 watchpoints_info (char *wpnum_exp, int from_tty)
5195 {
5196 int wpnum = -1, num_printed;
5197
5198 if (wpnum_exp)
5199 wpnum = parse_and_eval_long (wpnum_exp);
5200
5201 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (wpnum, 0, is_watchpoint);
5202
5203 if (num_printed == 0)
5204 {
5205 if (wpnum == -1)
5206 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
5207 else
5208 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint number %d.\n", wpnum);
5209 }
5210 }
5211
5212 static void
5213 maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *bnum_exp, int from_tty)
5214 {
5215 int bnum = -1;
5216
5217 if (bnum_exp)
5218 bnum = parse_and_eval_long (bnum_exp);
5219
5220 breakpoint_1 (bnum, 1, NULL);
5221
5222 default_collect_info ();
5223 }
5224
5225 static int
5226 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
5227 struct program_space *pspace,
5228 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
5229 {
5230 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
5231
5232 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
5233 {
5234 if (bl->pspace == pspace
5235 && bl->address == pc
5236 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
5237 return 1;
5238 }
5239 return 0;
5240 }
5241
5242 /* Print a message describing any breakpoints set at PC. This
5243 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
5244 address spaces. */
5245
5246 static void
5247 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5248 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
5249 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
5250 {
5251 int others = 0;
5252 struct breakpoint *b;
5253
5254 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5255 others += breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section);
5256 if (others > 0)
5257 {
5258 if (others == 1)
5259 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
5260 else /* if (others == ???) */
5261 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
5262 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5263 if (breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
5264 {
5265 others--;
5266 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
5267 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
5268 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
5269 else if (b->thread != -1)
5270 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
5271 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
5272 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
5273 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
5274 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
5275 ? " (disabled)"
5276 : b->enable_state == bp_permanent
5277 ? " (permanent)"
5278 : ""),
5279 (others > 1) ? ","
5280 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
5281 }
5282 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
5283 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
5284 printf_filtered (".\n");
5285 }
5286 }
5287 \f
5288 /* Set the default place to put a breakpoint
5289 for the `break' command with no arguments. */
5290
5291 void
5292 set_default_breakpoint (int valid, struct program_space *pspace,
5293 CORE_ADDR addr, struct symtab *symtab,
5294 int line)
5295 {
5296 default_breakpoint_valid = valid;
5297 default_breakpoint_pspace = pspace;
5298 default_breakpoint_address = addr;
5299 default_breakpoint_symtab = symtab;
5300 default_breakpoint_line = line;
5301 }
5302
5303 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
5304 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
5305 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
5306 (or use it for any other purpose either).
5307
5308 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
5309 always have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark
5310 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
5311 breakpoint at address zero:
5312
5313 bp_watchpoint
5314 bp_catchpoint
5315
5316 */
5317
5318 static int
5319 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5320 {
5321 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
5322
5323 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
5324 }
5325
5326 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
5327 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
5328
5329 static int
5330 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
5331 struct bp_location *loc2)
5332 {
5333 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5334 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5335 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5336
5337 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
5338 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
5339 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
5340 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
5341 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
5342 other watchpoint. */
5343 if ((loc1->owner->cond_exp
5344 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
5345 loc1->length,
5346 loc1->watchpoint_type,
5347 loc1->owner->cond_exp))
5348 || (loc2->owner->cond_exp
5349 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
5350 loc2->length,
5351 loc2->watchpoint_type,
5352 loc2->owner->cond_exp)))
5353 return 0;
5354
5355 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
5356 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
5357 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
5358 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
5359 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
5360 become hw_access locations later. */
5361 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
5362 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
5363 && loc1->address == loc2->address
5364 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
5365 }
5366
5367 /* Returns true if {ASPACE1,ADDR1} and {ASPACE2,ADDR2} represent the
5368 same breakpoint location. In most targets, this can only be true
5369 if ASPACE1 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global
5370 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
5371
5372 static int
5373 breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
5374 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
5375 {
5376 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch)
5377 || aspace1 == aspace2)
5378 && addr1 == addr2);
5379 }
5380
5381 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
5382 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
5383 represent the same location. */
5384
5385 static int
5386 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
5387 struct bp_location *loc2)
5388 {
5389 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
5390
5391 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
5392 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
5393 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
5394
5395 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
5396 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
5397
5398 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
5399 return 0;
5400 else if (hw_point1)
5401 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
5402 else
5403 return breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
5404 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address);
5405 }
5406
5407 static void
5408 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
5409 int bnum, int have_bnum)
5410 {
5411 char astr1[40];
5412 char astr2[40];
5413
5414 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
5415 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
5416 if (have_bnum)
5417 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
5418 bnum, astr1, astr2);
5419 else
5420 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
5421 }
5422
5423 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
5424 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
5425 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
5426 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
5427
5428 static CORE_ADDR
5429 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5430 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
5431 {
5432 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
5433 {
5434 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
5435 return bpaddr;
5436 }
5437 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
5438 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5439 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
5440 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
5441 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
5442 {
5443 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
5444 have their addresses modified. */
5445 return bpaddr;
5446 }
5447 else
5448 {
5449 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
5450
5451 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
5452 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
5453 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
5454
5455 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
5456 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
5457 is required. */
5458 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
5459 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
5460
5461 return adjusted_bpaddr;
5462 }
5463 }
5464
5465 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
5466
5467 static struct bp_location *
5468 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
5469 {
5470 struct bp_location *loc;
5471
5472 loc = xmalloc (sizeof (struct bp_location));
5473 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
5474
5475 loc->owner = bpt;
5476 loc->cond = NULL;
5477 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
5478 loc->enabled = 1;
5479
5480 switch (bpt->type)
5481 {
5482 case bp_breakpoint:
5483 case bp_until:
5484 case bp_finish:
5485 case bp_longjmp:
5486 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5487 case bp_exception:
5488 case bp_exception_resume:
5489 case bp_step_resume:
5490 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5491 case bp_call_dummy:
5492 case bp_std_terminate:
5493 case bp_shlib_event:
5494 case bp_thread_event:
5495 case bp_overlay_event:
5496 case bp_jit_event:
5497 case bp_longjmp_master:
5498 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5499 case bp_exception_master:
5500 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
5501 break;
5502 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5503 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
5504 break;
5505 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5506 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5507 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5508 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
5509 break;
5510 case bp_watchpoint:
5511 case bp_catchpoint:
5512 case bp_tracepoint:
5513 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5514 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5515 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
5516 break;
5517 default:
5518 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
5519 }
5520
5521 loc->refc = 1;
5522 return loc;
5523 }
5524
5525 static void
5526 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
5527 {
5528 if (loc->cond)
5529 xfree (loc->cond);
5530
5531 if (loc->function_name)
5532 xfree (loc->function_name);
5533
5534 xfree (loc);
5535 }
5536
5537 /* Increment reference count. */
5538
5539 static void
5540 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
5541 {
5542 ++bl->refc;
5543 }
5544
5545 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
5546 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
5547
5548 static void
5549 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
5550 {
5551 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
5552
5553 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
5554 free_bp_location (*blp);
5555 *blp = NULL;
5556 }
5557
5558 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint that has
5559 type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
5560 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
5561 static. */
5562
5563 static struct breakpoint *
5564 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5565 enum bptype bptype)
5566 {
5567 struct breakpoint *b, *b1;
5568
5569 b = (struct breakpoint *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct breakpoint));
5570 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
5571
5572 b->type = bptype;
5573 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
5574 b->language = current_language->la_language;
5575 b->input_radix = input_radix;
5576 b->thread = -1;
5577 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5578 b->next = 0;
5579 b->silent = 0;
5580 b->ignore_count = 0;
5581 b->commands = NULL;
5582 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
5583 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
5584 b->exec_pathname = NULL;
5585 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = NULL;
5586 b->ops = NULL;
5587 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
5588 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
5589
5590 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
5591 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
5592
5593 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
5594 if (b1 == 0)
5595 breakpoint_chain = b;
5596 else
5597 {
5598 while (b1->next)
5599 b1 = b1->next;
5600 b1->next = b;
5601 }
5602 return b;
5603 }
5604
5605 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
5606 static void
5607 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
5608 {
5609 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
5610
5611 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
5612 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
5613 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
5614 {
5615 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &(loc->function_name),
5616 NULL, NULL);
5617 if (loc->function_name)
5618 loc->function_name = xstrdup (loc->function_name);
5619 }
5620 }
5621
5622 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
5623 static struct gdbarch *
5624 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
5625 {
5626 if (sal.section)
5627 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
5628 if (sal.symtab)
5629 return get_objfile_arch (sal.symtab->objfile);
5630
5631 return NULL;
5632 }
5633
5634 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
5635 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
5636 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
5637 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
5638 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
5639 is also returned as the value of this function.
5640
5641 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
5642 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
5643 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
5644 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
5645 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
5646 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
5647 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
5648
5649 struct breakpoint *
5650 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
5651 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype)
5652 {
5653 struct breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch,
5654 bptype);
5655 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
5656 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch;
5657
5658 loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
5659 if (!loc_gdbarch)
5660 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
5661
5662 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
5663 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
5664
5665 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
5666 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
5667 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
5668 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
5669 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
5670 location that's only been partially initialized. */
5671 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
5672 sal.pc, b->type);
5673
5674 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
5675 b->loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
5676 b->loc->requested_address = sal.pc;
5677 b->loc->address = adjusted_address;
5678 b->loc->pspace = sal.pspace;
5679
5680 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint, for
5681 breakpoint resetting. */
5682 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
5683
5684 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
5685 b->source_file = NULL;
5686 else
5687 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
5688 b->loc->section = sal.section;
5689 b->line_number = sal.line;
5690
5691 set_breakpoint_location_function (b->loc);
5692
5693 breakpoints_changed ();
5694
5695 return b;
5696 }
5697
5698
5699 /* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
5700 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
5701 void
5702 make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
5703 {
5704 struct bp_location *bl;
5705
5706 b->enable_state = bp_permanent;
5707
5708 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
5709 code. Mark all locations as inserted. For now,
5710 make_breakpoint_permanent is called in just one place, so it's
5711 hard to say if it's reasonable to have permanent breakpoint with
5712 multiple locations or not, but it's easy to implmement. */
5713 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5714 bl->inserted = 1;
5715 }
5716
5717 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
5718 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
5719 initiated the operation. */
5720
5721 void
5722 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
5723 {
5724 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5725 int thread = tp->num;
5726
5727 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
5728 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
5729 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
5730 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
5731 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5732 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5733 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
5734 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
5735 {
5736 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5737
5738 clone->type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
5739 clone->thread = thread;
5740 }
5741
5742 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
5743 }
5744
5745 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
5746 void
5747 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
5748 {
5749 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5750
5751 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5752 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
5753 {
5754 if (b->thread == thread)
5755 delete_breakpoint (b);
5756 }
5757 }
5758
5759 void
5760 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5761 {
5762 struct breakpoint *b;
5763
5764 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5765 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5766 {
5767 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5768 update_global_location_list (1);
5769 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
5770 }
5771 }
5772
5773 void
5774 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
5775 {
5776 struct breakpoint *b;
5777
5778 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5779 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
5780 {
5781 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5782 update_global_location_list (0);
5783 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
5784 }
5785 }
5786
5787 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
5788 master breakpoint. */
5789 void
5790 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5791 {
5792 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5793
5794 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5795 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
5796 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
5797 {
5798 struct breakpoint *clone = clone_momentary_breakpoint (b);
5799 clone->type = bp_std_terminate;
5800 }
5801 }
5802
5803 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
5804 void
5805 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
5806 {
5807 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5808
5809 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5810 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
5811 delete_breakpoint (b);
5812 }
5813
5814 struct breakpoint *
5815 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5816 {
5817 struct breakpoint *b;
5818
5819 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event);
5820
5821 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
5822 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
5823 b->addr_string
5824 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
5825
5826 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5827
5828 return b;
5829 }
5830
5831 void
5832 remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
5833 {
5834 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5835
5836 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5837 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
5838 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5839 delete_breakpoint (b);
5840 }
5841
5842 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args
5843 {
5844 char **arg_p;
5845 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals_p;
5846 char ***addr_string_p;
5847 int *not_found_ptr;
5848 };
5849
5850 struct lang_and_radix
5851 {
5852 enum language lang;
5853 int radix;
5854 };
5855
5856 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
5857
5858 struct breakpoint *
5859 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5860 {
5861 struct breakpoint *b;
5862
5863 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event);
5864 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5865 return b;
5866 }
5867
5868 void
5869 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
5870 {
5871 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
5872
5873 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
5874 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
5875 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
5876 delete_breakpoint (b);
5877 }
5878
5879 struct breakpoint *
5880 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
5881 {
5882 struct breakpoint *b;
5883
5884 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event);
5885 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
5886 return b;
5887 }
5888
5889 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
5890 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
5891
5892 void
5893 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
5894 {
5895 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5896
5897 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5898 {
5899 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
5900 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5901
5902 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
5903 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
5904 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
5905 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
5906 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
5907 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
5908 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
5909 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5910 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
5911 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
5912 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5913 #ifdef PC_SOLIB
5914 && PC_SOLIB (loc->address)
5915 #else
5916 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
5917 #endif
5918 )
5919 {
5920 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5921 }
5922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 /* Disable any breakpoints that are in in an unloaded shared library.
5926 Only apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay
5927 disabled. */
5928
5929 static void
5930 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
5931 {
5932 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
5933 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
5934
5935 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
5936 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
5937 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
5938 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
5939 if (exec_bfd != NULL
5940 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
5941 return;
5942
5943 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
5944 {
5945 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
5946 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
5947
5948 if ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5949 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
5950 && solib->pspace == loc->pspace
5951 && !loc->shlib_disabled
5952 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
5953 || b->type == bp_jit_event
5954 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
5955 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
5956 {
5957 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
5958 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
5959 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
5960 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
5961 loc->inserted = 0;
5962 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
5963 {
5964 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5965 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
5966 solib->so_name);
5967 }
5968 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
5969 }
5970 }
5971 }
5972
5973 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
5974
5975 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5976 catchpoints. */
5977
5978 static void
5979 insert_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5980 {
5981 target_insert_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5982 }
5983
5984 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5985 catchpoints. */
5986
5987 static int
5988 remove_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5989 {
5990 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
5991 }
5992
5993 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
5994 catchpoints. */
5995
5996 static int
5997 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
5998 {
5999 return inferior_has_forked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
6000 }
6001
6002 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6003 catchpoints. */
6004
6005 static enum print_stop_action
6006 print_it_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
6007 {
6008 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6009 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (forked process %d), "),
6010 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6011 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6012 }
6013
6014 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6015 catchpoints. */
6016
6017 static void
6018 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6019 {
6020 struct value_print_options opts;
6021
6022 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6023
6024 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6025 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6026 readable). */
6027 if (opts.addressprint)
6028 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6029 annotate_field (5);
6030 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
6031 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
6032 {
6033 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
6034 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
6035 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6036 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
6037 }
6038 }
6039
6040 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6041 catchpoints. */
6042
6043 static void
6044 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
6045 {
6046 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
6047 }
6048
6049 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
6050 catchpoints. */
6051
6052 static void
6053 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6054 {
6055 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
6056 }
6057
6058 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
6059
6060 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops =
6061 {
6062 insert_catch_fork,
6063 remove_catch_fork,
6064 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork,
6065 print_it_catch_fork,
6066 print_one_catch_fork,
6067 print_mention_catch_fork,
6068 print_recreate_catch_fork
6069 };
6070
6071 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6072 catchpoints. */
6073
6074 static void
6075 insert_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6076 {
6077 target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6078 }
6079
6080 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6081 catchpoints. */
6082
6083 static int
6084 remove_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6085 {
6086 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6087 }
6088
6089 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6090 catchpoints. */
6091
6092 static int
6093 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6094 {
6095 return inferior_has_vforked (inferior_ptid, &b->forked_inferior_pid);
6096 }
6097
6098 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6099 catchpoints. */
6100
6101 static enum print_stop_action
6102 print_it_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6103 {
6104 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6105 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (vforked process %d), "),
6106 b->number, ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6107 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6108 }
6109
6110 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6111 catchpoints. */
6112
6113 static void
6114 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6115 {
6116 struct value_print_options opts;
6117
6118 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6119 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6120 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6121 readable). */
6122 if (opts.addressprint)
6123 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6124 annotate_field (5);
6125 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
6126 if (!ptid_equal (b->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
6127 {
6128 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
6129 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
6130 ptid_get_pid (b->forked_inferior_pid));
6131 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
6132 }
6133 }
6134
6135 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6136 catchpoints. */
6137
6138 static void
6139 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
6140 {
6141 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
6142 }
6143
6144 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
6145 catchpoints. */
6146
6147 static void
6148 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6149 {
6150 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
6151 }
6152
6153 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
6154
6155 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops =
6156 {
6157 insert_catch_vfork,
6158 remove_catch_vfork,
6159 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork,
6160 print_it_catch_vfork,
6161 print_one_catch_vfork,
6162 print_mention_catch_vfork,
6163 print_recreate_catch_vfork
6164 };
6165
6166 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6167 catchpoints. */
6168
6169 static void
6170 insert_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6171 {
6172 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
6173
6174 ++inf->total_syscalls_count;
6175 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6176 ++inf->any_syscall_count;
6177 else
6178 {
6179 int i, iter;
6180
6181 for (i = 0;
6182 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6183 i++)
6184 {
6185 int elem;
6186
6187 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6188 {
6189 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
6190 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
6191 uintptr_t vec_addr;
6192 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
6193 vec_addr = (uintptr_t) VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts) +
6194 vec_addr_offset;
6195 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
6196 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
6197 }
6198 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6199 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
6200 }
6201 }
6202
6203 target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6204 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6205 inf->any_syscall_count,
6206 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6207 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
6208 }
6209
6210 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6211 catchpoints. */
6212
6213 static int
6214 remove_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6215 {
6216 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
6217
6218 --inf->total_syscalls_count;
6219 if (!b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6220 --inf->any_syscall_count;
6221 else
6222 {
6223 int i, iter;
6224
6225 for (i = 0;
6226 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6227 i++)
6228 {
6229 int elem;
6230 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts))
6231 /* Shouldn't happen. */
6232 continue;
6233 elem = VEC_index (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter);
6234 VEC_replace (int, inf->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
6235 }
6236 }
6237
6238 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid),
6239 inf->total_syscalls_count != 0,
6240 inf->any_syscall_count,
6241 VEC_length (int, inf->syscalls_counts),
6242 VEC_address (int, inf->syscalls_counts));
6243 }
6244
6245 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6246 catchpoints. */
6247
6248 static int
6249 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6250 {
6251 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this
6252 breakpoint. If we are, then we must guarantee that the called
6253 syscall is the same syscall we are catching. */
6254 int syscall_number = 0;
6255
6256 if (!inferior_has_called_syscall (inferior_ptid, &syscall_number))
6257 return 0;
6258
6259 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
6260 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6261 {
6262 int i, iter;
6263
6264 for (i = 0;
6265 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6266 i++)
6267 if (syscall_number == iter)
6268 break;
6269 /* Not the same. */
6270 if (!iter)
6271 return 0;
6272 }
6273
6274 return 1;
6275 }
6276
6277 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6278 catchpoints. */
6279
6280 static enum print_stop_action
6281 print_it_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6282 {
6283 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
6284 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
6285 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
6286 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
6287 ptid_t ptid;
6288 struct target_waitstatus last;
6289 struct syscall s;
6290 struct cleanup *old_chain;
6291 char *syscall_id;
6292
6293 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
6294
6295 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
6296
6297 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6298
6299 if (s.name == NULL)
6300 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("%d", last.value.syscall_number);
6301 else
6302 syscall_id = xstrprintf ("'%s'", s.name);
6303
6304 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, syscall_id);
6305
6306 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
6307 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (call to syscall %s), "),
6308 b->number, syscall_id);
6309 else if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
6310 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (returned from syscall %s), "),
6311 b->number, syscall_id);
6312
6313 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6314
6315 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6316 }
6317
6318 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6319 catchpoints. */
6320
6321 static void
6322 print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
6323 struct bp_location **last_loc)
6324 {
6325 struct value_print_options opts;
6326
6327 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6328 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
6329 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
6330 readable). */
6331 if (opts.addressprint)
6332 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6333 annotate_field (5);
6334
6335 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught
6336 && VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6337 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
6338 else
6339 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
6340
6341 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6342 {
6343 int i, iter;
6344 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
6345
6346 for (i = 0;
6347 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6348 i++)
6349 {
6350 char *x = text;
6351 struct syscall s;
6352 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6353
6354 if (s.name != NULL)
6355 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
6356 else
6357 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
6358
6359 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
6360 because xstrprintf dinamically allocates new space for it
6361 on every call. */
6362 xfree (x);
6363 }
6364 /* Remove the last comma. */
6365 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
6366 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
6367 }
6368 else
6369 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
6370 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6371 }
6372
6373 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6374 catchpoints. */
6375
6376 static void
6377 print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
6378 {
6379 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6380 {
6381 int i, iter;
6382
6383 if (VEC_length (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
6384 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
6385 else
6386 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
6387
6388 for (i = 0;
6389 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6390 i++)
6391 {
6392 struct syscall s;
6393 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6394
6395 if (s.name)
6396 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
6397 else
6398 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
6399 }
6400 printf_filtered (")");
6401 }
6402 else
6403 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
6404 b->number);
6405 }
6406
6407 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
6408 catchpoints. */
6409
6410 static void
6411 print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6412 {
6413 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
6414
6415 if (b->syscalls_to_be_caught)
6416 {
6417 int i, iter;
6418
6419 for (i = 0;
6420 VEC_iterate (int, b->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
6421 i++)
6422 {
6423 struct syscall s;
6424
6425 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
6426 if (s.name)
6427 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
6428 else
6429 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
6430 }
6431 }
6432 }
6433
6434 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
6435
6436 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops =
6437 {
6438 insert_catch_syscall,
6439 remove_catch_syscall,
6440 breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall,
6441 print_it_catch_syscall,
6442 print_one_catch_syscall,
6443 print_mention_catch_syscall,
6444 print_recreate_catch_syscall
6445 };
6446
6447 /* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
6448
6449 static int
6450 syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6451 {
6452 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
6453 }
6454
6455 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it,
6456 but does NOT mention it nor update the global location list.
6457 This is useful if you need to fill more fields in the
6458 struct breakpoint before calling mention.
6459
6460 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6461 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6462 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6463 to the catchpoint. */
6464
6465 static struct breakpoint *
6466 create_catchpoint_without_mention (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6467 char *cond_string,
6468 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6469 {
6470 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6471 struct breakpoint *b;
6472
6473 init_sal (&sal);
6474 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
6475
6476 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint);
6477 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
6478 b->number = breakpoint_count;
6479
6480 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
6481 b->thread = -1;
6482 b->addr_string = NULL;
6483 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6484 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
6485 b->ops = ops;
6486
6487 return b;
6488 }
6489
6490 /* Create a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind and return it.
6491
6492 If TEMPFLAG is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary.
6493 If COND_STRING is not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint.
6494 OPS, if not NULL, is the breakpoint_ops structure associated
6495 to the catchpoint. */
6496
6497 static struct breakpoint *
6498 create_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
6499 char *cond_string, struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6500 {
6501 struct breakpoint *b =
6502 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6503
6504 mention (b);
6505 update_global_location_list (1);
6506
6507 return b;
6508 }
6509
6510 static void
6511 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6512 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
6513 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6514 {
6515 struct breakpoint *b
6516 = create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
6517
6518 /* FIXME: We should put this information in a breakpoint private data
6519 area. */
6520 b->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
6521 }
6522
6523 /* Exec catchpoints. */
6524
6525 static void
6526 insert_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6527 {
6528 target_insert_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6529 }
6530
6531 static int
6532 remove_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6533 {
6534 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (PIDGET (inferior_ptid));
6535 }
6536
6537 static int
6538 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6539 {
6540 return inferior_has_execd (inferior_ptid, &b->exec_pathname);
6541 }
6542
6543 static enum print_stop_action
6544 print_it_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6545 {
6546 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
6547 printf_filtered (_("\nCatchpoint %d (exec'd %s), "), b->number,
6548 b->exec_pathname);
6549 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
6550 }
6551
6552 static void
6553 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
6554 {
6555 struct value_print_options opts;
6556
6557 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6558
6559 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6560 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6561 is relatively readable). */
6562 if (opts.addressprint)
6563 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6564 annotate_field (5);
6565 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
6566 if (b->exec_pathname != NULL)
6567 {
6568 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
6569 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->exec_pathname);
6570 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
6571 }
6572 }
6573
6574 static void
6575 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
6576 {
6577 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
6578 }
6579
6580 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
6581 catchpoints. */
6582
6583 static void
6584 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
6585 {
6586 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
6587 }
6588
6589 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops =
6590 {
6591 insert_catch_exec,
6592 remove_catch_exec,
6593 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec,
6594 print_it_catch_exec,
6595 print_one_catch_exec,
6596 print_mention_catch_exec,
6597 print_recreate_catch_exec
6598 };
6599
6600 static void
6601 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
6602 struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
6603 {
6604 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
6605 struct breakpoint *b =
6606 create_catchpoint_without_mention (gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
6607
6608 b->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
6609
6610 /* Now, we have to mention the breakpoint and update the global
6611 location list. */
6612 mention (b);
6613 update_global_location_list (1);
6614 }
6615
6616 static int
6617 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
6618 {
6619 struct breakpoint *b;
6620 int i = 0;
6621
6622 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6623 {
6624 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6625 i++;
6626 }
6627
6628 return i;
6629 }
6630
6631 static int
6632 hw_watchpoint_used_count (enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
6633 {
6634 struct breakpoint *b;
6635 int i = 0;
6636
6637 *other_type_used = 0;
6638 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6639 {
6640 if (breakpoint_enabled (b))
6641 {
6642 if (b->type == type)
6643 i++;
6644 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
6645 *other_type_used = 1;
6646 }
6647 }
6648 return i;
6649 }
6650
6651 void
6652 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
6653 {
6654 struct breakpoint *b;
6655
6656 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6657 {
6658 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6659 {
6660 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
6661 update_global_location_list (0);
6662 }
6663 }
6664 }
6665
6666 void
6667 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
6668 {
6669 struct breakpoint *b;
6670
6671 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6672 {
6673 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6674 {
6675 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6676 update_global_location_list (1);
6677 }
6678 }
6679 }
6680
6681 void
6682 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
6683 {
6684 struct breakpoint *b;
6685 int found = 0;
6686
6687 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6688 {
6689 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6690 continue;
6691
6692 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6693 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6694 && breakpoint_enabled (b))
6695 {
6696 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
6697 found = 1;
6698 }
6699 }
6700
6701 if (found)
6702 update_global_location_list (0);
6703
6704 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
6705 }
6706
6707 void
6708 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
6709 {
6710 struct breakpoint *b;
6711 int found = 0;
6712
6713 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
6714
6715 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6716 {
6717 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
6718 continue;
6719
6720 if ((b->type == bp_breakpoint
6721 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
6722 && b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
6723 {
6724 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6725 found = 1;
6726 }
6727 }
6728
6729 if (found)
6730 breakpoint_re_set ();
6731 }
6732
6733
6734 /* Set a breakpoint that will evaporate an end of command
6735 at address specified by SAL.
6736 Restrict it to frame FRAME if FRAME is nonzero. */
6737
6738 struct breakpoint *
6739 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
6740 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
6741 {
6742 struct breakpoint *b;
6743
6744 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined
6745 one. */
6746 gdb_assert (!frame_id_inlined_p (frame_id));
6747
6748 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
6749 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6750 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6751 b->frame_id = frame_id;
6752
6753 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
6754 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
6755 control. */
6756 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
6757 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
6758
6759 update_global_location_list_nothrow (1);
6760
6761 return b;
6762 }
6763
6764 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
6765 ORIG is NULL. */
6766
6767 struct breakpoint *
6768 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
6769 {
6770 struct breakpoint *copy;
6771
6772 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
6773 if (orig == NULL)
6774 return NULL;
6775
6776 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, orig->type);
6777 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
6778 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
6779
6780 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
6781 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
6782 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
6783 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
6784 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
6785
6786 if (orig->source_file == NULL)
6787 copy->source_file = NULL;
6788 else
6789 copy->source_file = xstrdup (orig->source_file);
6790
6791 copy->line_number = orig->line_number;
6792 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
6793 copy->thread = orig->thread;
6794 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
6795
6796 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
6797 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
6798 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
6799
6800 update_global_location_list_nothrow (0);
6801 return copy;
6802 }
6803
6804 struct breakpoint *
6805 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
6806 enum bptype type)
6807 {
6808 struct symtab_and_line sal;
6809
6810 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
6811 sal.pc = pc;
6812 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
6813 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
6814
6815 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
6816 }
6817 \f
6818
6819 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
6820
6821 static void
6822 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
6823 {
6824 int say_where = 0;
6825 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
6826 struct value_print_options opts;
6827
6828 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6829
6830 /* FIXME: This is misplaced; mention() is called by things (like
6831 hitting a watchpoint) other than breakpoint creation. It should
6832 be possible to clean this up and at the same time replace the
6833 random calls to breakpoint_changed with this hook. */
6834 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
6835
6836 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_mention != NULL)
6837 b->ops->print_mention (b);
6838 else
6839 switch (b->type)
6840 {
6841 case bp_none:
6842 printf_filtered (_("(apparently deleted?) Eventpoint %d: "), b->number);
6843 break;
6844 case bp_watchpoint:
6845 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
6846 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6847 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6848 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6849 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6850 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6851 break;
6852 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6853 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
6854 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
6855 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6856 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6857 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6858 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6859 break;
6860 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6861 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
6862 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
6863 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6864 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6865 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6866 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6867 break;
6868 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6869 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
6870 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
6871 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6872 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
6873 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", b->exp_string);
6874 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
6875 break;
6876 case bp_breakpoint:
6877 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6878 {
6879 say_where = 0;
6880 break;
6881 }
6882 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
6883 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
6884 else
6885 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
6886 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6887 say_where = 1;
6888 break;
6889 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6890 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6891 {
6892 say_where = 0;
6893 break;
6894 }
6895 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
6896 say_where = 1;
6897 break;
6898 case bp_tracepoint:
6899 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6900 {
6901 say_where = 0;
6902 break;
6903 }
6904 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
6905 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6906 say_where = 1;
6907 break;
6908 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6909 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6910 {
6911 say_where = 0;
6912 break;
6913 }
6914 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
6915 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6916 say_where = 1;
6917 break;
6918 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6919 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6920 {
6921 say_where = 0;
6922 break;
6923 }
6924 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
6925 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
6926 say_where = 1;
6927 break;
6928
6929 case bp_until:
6930 case bp_finish:
6931 case bp_longjmp:
6932 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6933 case bp_exception:
6934 case bp_exception_resume:
6935 case bp_step_resume:
6936 case bp_call_dummy:
6937 case bp_std_terminate:
6938 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6939 case bp_shlib_event:
6940 case bp_thread_event:
6941 case bp_overlay_event:
6942 case bp_jit_event:
6943 case bp_longjmp_master:
6944 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6945 case bp_exception_master:
6946 break;
6947 }
6948
6949 if (say_where)
6950 {
6951 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
6952 single string. */
6953 if (b->loc == NULL)
6954 {
6955 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
6956 }
6957 else
6958 {
6959 if (opts.addressprint || b->source_file == NULL)
6960 {
6961 printf_filtered (" at ");
6962 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
6963 gdb_stdout);
6964 }
6965 if (b->source_file)
6966 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
6967 b->source_file, b->line_number);
6968
6969 if (b->loc->next)
6970 {
6971 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
6972 int n = 0;
6973 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
6974 ++n;
6975 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
6976 }
6977
6978 }
6979 }
6980 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6981 return;
6982 printf_filtered ("\n");
6983 }
6984 \f
6985
6986 static struct bp_location *
6987 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6988 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
6989 {
6990 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
6991
6992 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
6993 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
6994 ;
6995 *tmp = loc;
6996 loc->gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
6997 if (!loc->gdbarch)
6998 loc->gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
6999 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
7000 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7001 loc->requested_address, b->type);
7002 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
7003 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
7004 loc->section = sal->section;
7005
7006 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
7007 return loc;
7008 }
7009 \f
7010
7011 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
7012 return 0 otherwise. */
7013
7014 static int
7015 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
7016 {
7017 int len;
7018 CORE_ADDR addr;
7019 const gdb_byte *brk;
7020 gdb_byte *target_mem;
7021 struct cleanup *cleanup;
7022 int retval = 0;
7023
7024 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
7025
7026 addr = loc->address;
7027 brk = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
7028
7029 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
7030 if (brk == NULL)
7031 return 0;
7032
7033 target_mem = alloca (len);
7034
7035 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
7036 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
7037 breakpoints they are permanent. */
7038 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7039
7040 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
7041 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
7042
7043 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
7044 && memcmp (target_mem, brk, len) == 0)
7045 retval = 1;
7046
7047 do_cleanups (cleanup);
7048
7049 return retval;
7050 }
7051
7052
7053
7054 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
7055 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
7056 as condition expression. */
7057
7058 static void
7059 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7060 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
7061 char *cond_string,
7062 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
7063 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
7064 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
7065 int enabled, int internal)
7066 {
7067 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
7068 int i;
7069
7070 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7071 {
7072 int i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
7073 int target_resources_ok =
7074 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
7075 i + 1, 0);
7076 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
7077 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
7078 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
7079 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
7080 }
7081
7082 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
7083
7084 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7085 {
7086 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
7087 struct bp_location *loc;
7088
7089 if (from_tty)
7090 {
7091 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
7092 if (!loc_gdbarch)
7093 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
7094
7095 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
7096 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
7097 }
7098
7099 if (i == 0)
7100 {
7101 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type);
7102 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
7103 b->thread = thread;
7104 b->task = task;
7105
7106 b->cond_string = cond_string;
7107 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7108 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7109 b->disposition = disposition;
7110 b->pspace = sals.sals[0].pspace;
7111
7112 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
7113 {
7114 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
7115
7116 if (is_marker_spec (addr_string))
7117 {
7118 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
7119 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
7120 char *p = &addr_string[3];
7121 char *endp;
7122 char *marker_str;
7123 int i;
7124
7125 while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
7126 p++;
7127
7128 endp = p;
7129 while (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7130 endp++;
7131
7132 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
7133 b->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
7134
7135 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"),
7136 b->static_trace_marker_id);
7137 }
7138 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
7139 {
7140 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
7141 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
7142
7143 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"),
7144 b->static_trace_marker_id);
7145 }
7146 else
7147 warning (_("\
7148 Couldn't determine the static tracepoint marker to probe"));
7149 }
7150
7151 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7152 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7153 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7154 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7155
7156 loc = b->loc;
7157 }
7158 else
7159 {
7160 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7161 }
7162
7163 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
7164 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
7165
7166 if (b->cond_string)
7167 {
7168 char *arg = b->cond_string;
7169 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
7170 if (*arg)
7171 error (_("Garbage %s follows condition"), arg);
7172 }
7173 }
7174
7175 if (addr_string)
7176 b->addr_string = addr_string;
7177 else
7178 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
7179 me. */
7180 b->addr_string
7181 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
7182
7183 b->ops = ops;
7184 if (internal)
7185 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number, but do
7186 notify observers. */
7187 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
7188 else
7189 mention (b);
7190 }
7191
7192 /* Remove element at INDEX_TO_REMOVE from SAL, shifting other
7193 elements to fill the void space. */
7194 static void
7195 remove_sal (struct symtabs_and_lines *sal, int index_to_remove)
7196 {
7197 int i = index_to_remove+1;
7198 int last_index = sal->nelts-1;
7199
7200 for (;i <= last_index; ++i)
7201 sal->sals[i-1] = sal->sals[i];
7202
7203 --(sal->nelts);
7204 }
7205
7206 /* If appropriate, obtains all sals that correspond to the same file
7207 and line as SAL, in all program spaces. Users debugging with IDEs,
7208 will want to set a breakpoint at foo.c:line, and not really care
7209 about program spaces. This is done only if SAL does not have
7210 explicit PC and has line and file information. If we got just a
7211 single expanded sal, return the original.
7212
7213 Otherwise, if SAL.explicit_line is not set, filter out all sals for
7214 which the name of enclosing function is different from SAL. This
7215 makes sure that if we have breakpoint originally set in template
7216 instantiation, say foo<int>(), we won't expand SAL to locations at
7217 the same line in all existing instantiations of 'foo'. */
7218
7219 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7220 expand_line_sal_maybe (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7221 {
7222 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7223 CORE_ADDR original_pc = sal.pc;
7224 char *original_function = NULL;
7225 int found;
7226 int i;
7227 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7228
7229 /* If we have explicit pc, don't expand.
7230 If we have no line number, we can't expand. */
7231 if (sal.explicit_pc || sal.line == 0 || sal.symtab == NULL)
7232 {
7233 expanded.nelts = 1;
7234 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7235 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7236 return expanded;
7237 }
7238
7239 sal.pc = 0;
7240
7241 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7242
7243 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
7244
7245 find_pc_partial_function (original_pc, &original_function, NULL, NULL);
7246
7247 /* Note that expand_line_sal visits *all* program spaces. */
7248 expanded = expand_line_sal (sal);
7249
7250 if (expanded.nelts == 1)
7251 {
7252 /* We had one sal, we got one sal. Return that sal, adjusting it
7253 past the function prologue if necessary. */
7254 xfree (expanded.sals);
7255 expanded.nelts = 1;
7256 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7257 sal.pc = original_pc;
7258 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7259 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[0]);
7260 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7261 return expanded;
7262 }
7263
7264 if (!sal.explicit_line)
7265 {
7266 CORE_ADDR func_addr, func_end;
7267 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7268 {
7269 CORE_ADDR pc = expanded.sals[i].pc;
7270 char *this_function;
7271
7272 /* We need to switch threads as well since we're about to
7273 read memory. */
7274 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (expanded.sals[i].pspace);
7275
7276 if (find_pc_partial_function (pc, &this_function,
7277 &func_addr, &func_end))
7278 {
7279 if (this_function
7280 && strcmp (this_function, original_function) != 0)
7281 {
7282 remove_sal (&expanded, i);
7283 --i;
7284 }
7285 }
7286 }
7287 }
7288
7289 /* Skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7290 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7291 skip_prologue_sal (&expanded.sals[i]);
7292
7293 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7294
7295 if (expanded.nelts <= 1)
7296 {
7297 /* This is un ugly workaround. If we get zero expanded sals
7298 then something is really wrong. Fix that by returning the
7299 original sal. */
7300
7301 xfree (expanded.sals);
7302 expanded.nelts = 1;
7303 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7304 sal.pc = original_pc;
7305 expanded.sals[0] = sal;
7306 return expanded;
7307 }
7308
7309 if (original_pc)
7310 {
7311 found = 0;
7312 for (i = 0; i < expanded.nelts; ++i)
7313 if (expanded.sals[i].pc == original_pc)
7314 {
7315 found = 1;
7316 break;
7317 }
7318 gdb_assert (found);
7319 }
7320
7321 return expanded;
7322 }
7323
7324 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
7325 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
7326 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
7327 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
7328 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
7329 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
7330 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
7331 we take just a single condition string.
7332
7333 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
7334 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
7335 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
7336 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
7337 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
7338
7339 static void
7340 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7341 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char **addr_string,
7342 char *cond_string,
7343 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
7344 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
7345 struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
7346 int enabled, int internal)
7347 {
7348 int i;
7349
7350 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7351 {
7352 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded =
7353 expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[i]);
7354
7355 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7356 cond_string, type, disposition,
7357 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
7358 from_tty, enabled, internal);
7359 }
7360 }
7361
7362 /* Parse ARG which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
7363 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
7364 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
7365 address strings. ARG points to the end of the SAL. */
7366
7367 static void
7368 parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
7369 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals,
7370 char ***addr_string,
7371 int *not_found_ptr)
7372 {
7373 char *addr_start = *address;
7374
7375 *addr_string = NULL;
7376 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
7377 breakpoint. */
7378 if ((*address) == NULL
7379 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
7380 {
7381 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
7382 {
7383 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7384
7385 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
7386 sals->sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
7387 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7388 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
7389 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
7390 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
7391 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
7392 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
7393
7394 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
7395 where PC is the default_breakpoint_address. So make sure
7396 to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from trying to
7397 expand the list of sals to include all other instances
7398 with the same symtab and line. */
7399 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
7400
7401 sals->sals[0] = sal;
7402 sals->nelts = 1;
7403 }
7404 else
7405 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
7406 }
7407 else
7408 {
7409 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
7410 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
7411 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
7412 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
7413
7414 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
7415 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '[' */
7416
7417 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
7418
7419 if (default_breakpoint_valid
7420 && (!cursal.symtab
7421 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
7422 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
7423 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
7424 default_breakpoint_line, addr_string,
7425 not_found_ptr);
7426 else
7427 *sals = decode_line_1 (address, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
7428 addr_string, not_found_ptr);
7429 }
7430 /* For any SAL that didn't have a canonical string, fill one in. */
7431 if (sals->nelts > 0 && *addr_string == NULL)
7432 *addr_string = xcalloc (sals->nelts, sizeof (char **));
7433 if (addr_start != (*address))
7434 {
7435 int i;
7436
7437 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7438 {
7439 /* Add the string if not present. */
7440 if ((*addr_string)[i] == NULL)
7441 (*addr_string)[i] = savestring (addr_start,
7442 (*address) - addr_start);
7443 }
7444 }
7445 }
7446
7447
7448 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
7449 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
7450
7451 static void
7452 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7453 {
7454 int i;
7455
7456 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7457 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
7458 }
7459
7460 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
7461 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
7462 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
7463 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
7464 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
7465 it, etc. */
7466
7467 static void
7468 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7469 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
7470 {
7471 int i, rslt;
7472 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
7473 char *msg;
7474 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7475
7476 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
7477 {
7478 sal = &sals->sals[i];
7479
7480 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (gdbarch, sal->pc,
7481 NULL, &msg);
7482 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
7483
7484 if (!rslt)
7485 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
7486 paddress (gdbarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
7487
7488 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7489 }
7490 }
7491
7492 static void
7493 do_captured_parse_breakpoint (struct ui_out *ui, void *data)
7494 {
7495 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args *args = data;
7496
7497 parse_breakpoint_sals (args->arg_p, args->sals_p, args->addr_string_p,
7498 args->not_found_ptr);
7499 }
7500
7501 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
7502 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
7503 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
7504 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
7505 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
7506 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
7507 static void
7508 find_condition_and_thread (char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
7509 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task)
7510 {
7511 *cond_string = NULL;
7512 *thread = -1;
7513 while (tok && *tok)
7514 {
7515 char *end_tok;
7516 int toklen;
7517 char *cond_start = NULL;
7518 char *cond_end = NULL;
7519
7520 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
7521 tok++;
7522
7523 end_tok = tok;
7524
7525 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
7526 end_tok++;
7527
7528 toklen = end_tok - tok;
7529
7530 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
7531 {
7532 struct expression *expr;
7533
7534 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
7535 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
7536 xfree (expr);
7537 cond_end = tok;
7538 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start,
7539 cond_end - cond_start);
7540 }
7541 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
7542 {
7543 char *tmptok;
7544
7545 tok = end_tok + 1;
7546 tmptok = tok;
7547 *thread = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7548 if (tok == tmptok)
7549 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
7550 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
7551 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), *thread);
7552 }
7553 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
7554 {
7555 char *tmptok;
7556
7557 tok = end_tok + 1;
7558 tmptok = tok;
7559 *task = strtol (tok, &tok, 0);
7560 if (tok == tmptok)
7561 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
7562 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
7563 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
7564 }
7565 else
7566 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
7567 }
7568 }
7569
7570 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
7571
7572 static struct symtabs_and_lines
7573 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
7574 {
7575 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
7576 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7577 struct symtab_and_line sal;
7578 struct symbol *sym;
7579 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7580 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
7581 char *endp;
7582 char *marker_str;
7583 int i;
7584
7585 while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
7586 p++;
7587
7588 endp = p;
7589 while (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
7590 endp++;
7591
7592 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
7593 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
7594
7595 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
7596 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
7597 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
7598
7599 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
7600 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
7601
7602 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7603 {
7604 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
7605
7606 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
7607
7608 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
7609
7610 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
7611 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
7612
7613 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
7614 }
7615
7616 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7617
7618 *arg_p = endp;
7619 return sals;
7620 }
7621
7622 /* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
7623 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
7624 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_CONDITION_AND_THREAD
7625 parameter. If non-zero, the function will parse arg, extracting
7626 breakpoint location, address and thread. Otherwise, ARG is just
7627 the location of breakpoint, with condition and thread specified by
7628 the COND_STRING and THREAD parameters. If INTERNAL is non-zero,
7629 the breakpoint number will be allocated from the internal
7630 breakpoint count. Returns true if any breakpoint was created;
7631 false otherwise. */
7632
7633 int
7634 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7635 char *arg, char *cond_string, int thread,
7636 int parse_condition_and_thread,
7637 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
7638 int ignore_count,
7639 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
7640 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
7641 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal)
7642 {
7643 struct gdb_exception e;
7644 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
7645 struct symtab_and_line pending_sal;
7646 char *copy_arg;
7647 char *addr_start = arg;
7648 char **addr_string;
7649 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7650 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
7651 struct captured_parse_breakpoint_args parse_args;
7652 int i;
7653 int pending = 0;
7654 int not_found = 0;
7655 int task = 0;
7656 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
7657
7658 sals.sals = NULL;
7659 sals.nelts = 0;
7660 addr_string = NULL;
7661
7662 parse_args.arg_p = &arg;
7663 parse_args.sals_p = &sals;
7664 parse_args.addr_string_p = &addr_string;
7665 parse_args.not_found_ptr = &not_found;
7666
7667 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (arg))
7668 {
7669 int i;
7670
7671 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
7672
7673 copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, arg - addr_start);
7674 addr_string = xcalloc (sals.nelts, sizeof (char **));
7675 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7676 addr_string[i] = xstrdup (copy_arg);
7677 goto done;
7678 }
7679
7680 e = catch_exception (uiout, do_captured_parse_breakpoint,
7681 &parse_args, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
7682
7683 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
7684 switch (e.reason)
7685 {
7686 case RETURN_QUIT:
7687 throw_exception (e);
7688 case RETURN_ERROR:
7689 switch (e.error)
7690 {
7691 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
7692
7693 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
7694 error. */
7695
7696 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
7697 throw_exception (e);
7698
7699 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
7700
7701 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
7702 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
7703 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
7704 && !nquery (_("Make breakpoint pending on future shared library load? ")))
7705 return 0;
7706
7707 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
7708 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
7709 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
7710 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
7711 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
7712 addr_string = &copy_arg;
7713 sals.nelts = 1;
7714 sals.sals = &pending_sal;
7715 pending_sal.pc = 0;
7716 pending = 1;
7717 break;
7718 default:
7719 throw_exception (e);
7720 }
7721 default:
7722 if (!sals.nelts)
7723 return 0;
7724 }
7725
7726 done:
7727
7728 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
7729 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7730
7731 if (!pending)
7732 {
7733 /* Make sure that all storage allocated to SALS gets freed. */
7734 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
7735
7736 /* Cleanup the addr_string array but not its contents. */
7737 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
7738 }
7739
7740 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
7741 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
7742 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
7743 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
7744 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
7745
7746 /* Mark the contents of the addr_string for cleanup. These go on
7747 the bkpt_chain and only occur if the breakpoint create fails. */
7748 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
7749 {
7750 if (addr_string[i] != NULL)
7751 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string[i]);
7752 }
7753
7754 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
7755 are ok for the target. */
7756 if (!pending)
7757 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&sals);
7758
7759 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
7760 if (type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
7761 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &sals);
7762
7763 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
7764 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
7765 breakpoint. */
7766 if (!pending)
7767 {
7768 if (parse_condition_and_thread)
7769 {
7770 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
7771 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
7772 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
7773 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
7774 cond_string = NULL;
7775 thread = -1;
7776 find_condition_and_thread (arg, sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
7777 &thread, &task);
7778 if (cond_string)
7779 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7780 }
7781 else
7782 {
7783 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
7784 if (cond_string)
7785 {
7786 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
7787 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
7788 }
7789 }
7790
7791 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
7792 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
7793 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
7794 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
7795 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
7796 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
7797 if (type_wanted == bp_static_tracepoint
7798 && is_marker_spec (addr_string[0]))
7799 {
7800 int i;
7801
7802 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
7803 {
7804 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
7805 struct breakpoint *tp;
7806 struct cleanup *old_chain;
7807
7808 expanded.nelts = 1;
7809 expanded.sals = xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
7810 expanded.sals[0] = sals.sals[i];
7811 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, expanded.sals);
7812
7813 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, expanded, addr_string[i],
7814 cond_string, type_wanted,
7815 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7816 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
7817 from_tty, enabled, internal);
7818
7819 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7820
7821 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
7822 if (internal)
7823 tp = get_breakpoint (internal_breakpoint_number);
7824 else
7825 tp = get_breakpoint (breakpoint_count);
7826 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
7827
7828 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
7829 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
7830 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
7831 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
7832 try to match up which of the newly found markers
7833 corresponds to this one */
7834 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
7835 }
7836 }
7837 else
7838 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, sals, addr_string, cond_string,
7839 type_wanted, tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
7840 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
7841 enabled, internal);
7842 }
7843 else
7844 {
7845 struct breakpoint *b;
7846
7847 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
7848
7849 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (gdbarch, type_wanted);
7850 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
7851 b->thread = -1;
7852 b->addr_string = addr_string[0];
7853 b->cond_string = NULL;
7854 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
7855 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
7856 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
7857 b->ops = ops;
7858 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
7859 b->pspace = current_program_space;
7860 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7861
7862 if (enabled && b->pspace->executing_startup
7863 && (b->type == bp_breakpoint
7864 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint))
7865 b->enable_state = bp_startup_disabled;
7866
7867 if (internal)
7868 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number,
7869 but do notify observers. */
7870 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
7871 else
7872 mention (b);
7873 }
7874
7875 if (sals.nelts > 1)
7876 {
7877 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\n"
7878 "Use the \"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
7879 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
7880 }
7881
7882 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
7883 breakpoint. */
7884 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
7885 /* But cleanup everything else. */
7886 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7887
7888 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
7889 update_global_location_list (1);
7890
7891 return 1;
7892 }
7893
7894 /* Set a breakpoint.
7895 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
7896 condition, and thread.
7897 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
7898 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
7899 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
7900
7901 static void
7902 break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
7903 {
7904 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
7905 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
7906 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
7907 : bp_breakpoint);
7908
7909 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
7910 arg,
7911 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
7912 tempflag, type_wanted,
7913 0 /* Ignore count */,
7914 pending_break_support,
7915 NULL /* breakpoint_ops */,
7916 from_tty,
7917 1 /* enabled */,
7918 0 /* internal */);
7919 }
7920
7921
7922 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
7923
7924 void
7925 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
7926 {
7927 CORE_ADDR pc;
7928
7929 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7930 {
7931 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
7932 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
7933 sal->line, sal->symtab->filename);
7934 sal->pc = pc;
7935
7936 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
7937 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
7938 if (sal->explicit_line)
7939 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
7940 }
7941
7942 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
7943 {
7944 struct blockvector *bv;
7945 struct block *b;
7946 struct symbol *sym;
7947
7948 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
7949 if (bv != NULL)
7950 {
7951 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
7952 if (sym != NULL)
7953 {
7954 fixup_symbol_section (sym, sal->symtab->objfile);
7955 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (sym);
7956 }
7957 else
7958 {
7959 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
7960 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
7961 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
7962 happen in assembly source). */
7963
7964 struct minimal_symbol *msym;
7965 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
7966
7967 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
7968
7969 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
7970 if (msym)
7971 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym);
7972
7973 do_cleanups (old_chain);
7974 }
7975 }
7976 }
7977 }
7978
7979 void
7980 break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7981 {
7982 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
7983 }
7984
7985 void
7986 tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7987 {
7988 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
7989 }
7990
7991 static void
7992 hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7993 {
7994 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
7995 }
7996
7997 static void
7998 thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
7999 {
8000 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
8001 }
8002
8003 static void
8004 stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8005 {
8006 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
8007 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
8008 stop at <line>\n"));
8009 }
8010
8011 static void
8012 stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8013 {
8014 int badInput = 0;
8015
8016 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
8017 badInput = 1;
8018 else if (*arg != '*')
8019 {
8020 char *argptr = arg;
8021 int hasColon = 0;
8022
8023 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
8024 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
8025 function/method name. */
8026 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
8027 {
8028 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
8029 argptr++;
8030 }
8031
8032 if (hasColon)
8033 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
8034 else
8035 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
8036 }
8037
8038 if (badInput)
8039 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
8040 else
8041 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
8042 }
8043
8044 static void
8045 stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8046 {
8047 int badInput = 0;
8048
8049 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
8050 badInput = 1;
8051 else
8052 {
8053 char *argptr = arg;
8054 int hasColon = 0;
8055
8056 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
8057 it is probably a line number. */
8058 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
8059 {
8060 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
8061 argptr++;
8062 }
8063
8064 if (hasColon)
8065 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
8066 else
8067 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
8068 }
8069
8070 if (badInput)
8071 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
8072 else
8073 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
8074 }
8075
8076 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
8077 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
8078 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
8079 zero. */
8080 static int
8081 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
8082 {
8083 int i = exp->nelts;
8084
8085 while (i > 0)
8086 {
8087 int oplenp, argsp;
8088
8089 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
8090 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
8091 i -= oplenp;
8092
8093 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
8094 {
8095 case BINOP_ADD:
8096 case BINOP_SUB:
8097 case BINOP_MUL:
8098 case BINOP_DIV:
8099 case BINOP_REM:
8100 case BINOP_MOD:
8101 case BINOP_LSH:
8102 case BINOP_RSH:
8103 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
8104 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
8105 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
8106 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
8107 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
8108 case BINOP_EQUAL:
8109 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
8110 case BINOP_LESS:
8111 case BINOP_GTR:
8112 case BINOP_LEQ:
8113 case BINOP_GEQ:
8114 case BINOP_REPEAT:
8115 case BINOP_COMMA:
8116 case BINOP_EXP:
8117 case BINOP_MIN:
8118 case BINOP_MAX:
8119 case BINOP_INTDIV:
8120 case BINOP_CONCAT:
8121 case BINOP_IN:
8122 case BINOP_RANGE:
8123 case TERNOP_COND:
8124 case TERNOP_SLICE:
8125 case TERNOP_SLICE_COUNT:
8126
8127 case OP_LONG:
8128 case OP_DOUBLE:
8129 case OP_DECFLOAT:
8130 case OP_LAST:
8131 case OP_COMPLEX:
8132 case OP_STRING:
8133 case OP_BITSTRING:
8134 case OP_ARRAY:
8135 case OP_TYPE:
8136 case OP_NAME:
8137 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
8138
8139 case UNOP_NEG:
8140 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
8141 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
8142 case UNOP_ADDR:
8143 case UNOP_HIGH:
8144 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
8145 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
8146 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
8147 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
8148
8149 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
8150 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
8151 ADDR is. */
8152 break;
8153
8154 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
8155 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
8156
8157 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
8158 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
8159 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
8160 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
8161
8162 We also have to check for function symbols because they
8163 are always constant. */
8164 {
8165 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
8166
8167 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
8168 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
8169 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
8170 return 0;
8171 break;
8172 }
8173
8174 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
8175 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
8176 then it is not a constant. */
8177 default:
8178 return 0;
8179 }
8180 }
8181
8182 return 1;
8183 }
8184
8185 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
8186 hw_read: watch read,
8187 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
8188 static void
8189 watch_command_1 (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
8190 int just_location, int internal)
8191 {
8192 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
8193 struct expression *exp;
8194 struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
8195 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
8196 struct frame_info *frame;
8197 char *exp_start = NULL;
8198 char *exp_end = NULL;
8199 char *tok, *id_tok_start, *end_tok;
8200 int toklen;
8201 char *cond_start = NULL;
8202 char *cond_end = NULL;
8203 int i, other_type_used, target_resources_ok = 0;
8204 enum bptype bp_type;
8205 int mem_cnt = 0;
8206 int thread = -1;
8207 int pc = 0;
8208
8209 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
8210 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
8211 {
8212 toklen = strlen (arg); /* Size of argument list. */
8213
8214 /* Points tok to the end of the argument list. */
8215 tok = arg + toklen - 1;
8216
8217 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip the last
8218 parameter. If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>'
8219 parameter, this should be the thread identifier. */
8220 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8221 tok--;
8222 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8223 tok--;
8224
8225 /* Points end_tok to the beginning of the last token. */
8226 id_tok_start = tok + 1;
8227
8228 /* Go backwards in the parameters list. Skip one more
8229 parameter. If we're expecting a 'thread <thread_num>'
8230 parameter, we should reach a "thread" token. */
8231 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
8232 tok--;
8233
8234 end_tok = tok;
8235
8236 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
8237 tok--;
8238
8239 /* Move the pointer forward to skip the whitespace and
8240 calculate the length of the token. */
8241 tok++;
8242 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8243
8244 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
8245 {
8246 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
8247 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
8248 only in a specific thread. */
8249 char *endp;
8250
8251 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
8252 thread = strtol (id_tok_start, &endp, 0);
8253
8254 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
8255 thread ID. */
8256 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
8257 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), id_tok_start);
8258
8259 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
8260 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
8261 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), thread);
8262
8263 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the thread <thread_num>
8264 parameter before the parameter list is parsed by the
8265 evaluate_expression() function. */
8266 *tok = '\0';
8267 }
8268 }
8269
8270 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. */
8271 innermost_block = NULL;
8272 exp_start = arg;
8273 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0);
8274 exp_end = arg;
8275 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
8276 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
8277 prettier. */
8278 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
8279 --exp_end;
8280
8281 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
8282 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
8283 {
8284 int len;
8285
8286 len = exp_end - exp_start;
8287 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
8288 len--;
8289 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
8290 }
8291
8292 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8293 mark = value_mark ();
8294 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL);
8295
8296 if (just_location)
8297 {
8298 exp_valid_block = NULL;
8299 val = value_addr (result);
8300 release_value (val);
8301 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8302 }
8303 else if (val != NULL)
8304 release_value (val);
8305
8306 tok = arg;
8307 while (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')
8308 tok++;
8309 end_tok = tok;
8310
8311 while (*end_tok != ' ' && *end_tok != '\t' && *end_tok != '\000')
8312 end_tok++;
8313
8314 toklen = end_tok - tok;
8315 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
8316 {
8317 struct expression *cond;
8318
8319 innermost_block = NULL;
8320 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
8321 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0);
8322
8323 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
8324 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
8325 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
8326
8327 xfree (cond);
8328 cond_end = tok;
8329 }
8330 if (*tok)
8331 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
8332
8333 if (accessflag == hw_read)
8334 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
8335 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
8336 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
8337 else
8338 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
8339
8340 mem_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val);
8341 if (mem_cnt == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8342 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint."));
8343 if (mem_cnt != 0)
8344 {
8345 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count (bp_type, &other_type_used);
8346 target_resources_ok =
8347 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_type, i + mem_cnt,
8348 other_type_used);
8349 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8350 error (_("Target does not support this type of hardware watchpoint."));
8351
8352 if (target_resources_ok < 0 && bp_type != bp_hardware_watchpoint)
8353 error (_("Target can only support one kind of HW watchpoint at a time."));
8354 }
8355
8356 /* Change the type of breakpoint to an ordinary watchpoint if a
8357 hardware watchpoint could not be set. */
8358 if (!mem_cnt || target_resources_ok <= 0)
8359 bp_type = bp_watchpoint;
8360
8361 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
8362
8363 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
8364 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
8365 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
8366 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
8367 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
8368 {
8369 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8370 {
8371 scope_breakpoint
8372 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8373 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
8374 bp_watchpoint_scope);
8375
8376 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8377
8378 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
8379 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
8380
8381 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
8382 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
8383
8384 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
8385 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
8386 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
8387 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
8388 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8389 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
8390 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
8391 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
8392 scope_breakpoint->type);
8393 }
8394 }
8395
8396 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
8397 b = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (NULL, bp_type);
8398 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8399 b->thread = thread;
8400 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8401 b->exp = exp;
8402 b->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
8403 b->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
8404 if (just_location)
8405 {
8406 struct type *t = value_type (val);
8407 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
8408 char *name;
8409
8410 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
8411 name = type_to_string (t);
8412
8413 b->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
8414 core_addr_to_string (addr));
8415 xfree (name);
8416
8417 b->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location: %.*s",
8418 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
8419
8420 /* The above expression is in C. */
8421 b->language = language_c;
8422 }
8423 else
8424 b->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
8425 b->val = val;
8426 b->val_valid = 1;
8427 if (cond_start)
8428 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
8429 else
8430 b->cond_string = 0;
8431
8432 if (frame)
8433 {
8434 b->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
8435 b->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
8436 }
8437 else
8438 {
8439 b->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
8440 b->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
8441 }
8442
8443 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
8444 {
8445 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
8446 need to act on them together. */
8447 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
8448 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
8449 }
8450
8451 if (!just_location)
8452 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8453
8454 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
8455 that should be inserted. */
8456 update_watchpoint (b, 1);
8457 if (internal)
8458 /* Do not mention breakpoints with a negative number, but do
8459 notify observers. */
8460 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b->number);
8461 else
8462 mention (b);
8463 update_global_location_list (1);
8464 }
8465
8466 /* Return count of locations need to be watched and can be handled in
8467 hardware. If the watchpoint can not be handled in hardware return
8468 zero. */
8469
8470 static int
8471 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
8472 {
8473 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
8474 struct value *head = v;
8475
8476 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
8477 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
8478 return 0;
8479
8480 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
8481 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
8482 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
8483 hardware watchpoint.
8484
8485 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
8486 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
8487 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
8488 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
8489 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
8490 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
8491 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
8492 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
8493 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
8494
8495 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
8496 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
8497 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
8498 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
8499 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
8500 {
8501 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
8502 {
8503 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
8504 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
8505 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
8506 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
8507 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
8508 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
8509 ;
8510 else
8511 {
8512 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
8513 it with hardware watchpoints. */
8514 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
8515
8516 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
8517 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
8518 middle of some value chain. */
8519 if (v == head
8520 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
8521 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
8522 {
8523 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
8524 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
8525
8526 if (!target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len))
8527 return 0;
8528 else
8529 found_memory_cnt++;
8530 }
8531 }
8532 }
8533 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
8534 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
8535 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
8536 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
8537 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
8538 }
8539
8540 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
8541 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
8542 return found_memory_cnt;
8543 }
8544
8545 void
8546 watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8547 {
8548 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
8549 }
8550
8551 /* A helper function that looks for an argument at the start of a
8552 string. The argument must also either be at the end of the string,
8553 or be followed by whitespace. Returns 1 if it finds the argument,
8554 0 otherwise. If the argument is found, it updates *STR. */
8555
8556 static int
8557 check_for_argument (char **str, char *arg, int arg_len)
8558 {
8559 if (strncmp (*str, arg, arg_len) == 0
8560 && ((*str)[arg_len] == '\0' || isspace ((*str)[arg_len])))
8561 {
8562 *str += arg_len;
8563 return 1;
8564 }
8565 return 0;
8566 }
8567
8568 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
8569 calls watch_command_1. */
8570
8571 static void
8572 watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
8573 {
8574 int just_location = 0;
8575
8576 if (arg
8577 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
8578 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
8579 {
8580 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8581 just_location = 1;
8582 }
8583
8584 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
8585 }
8586
8587 static void
8588 watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8589 {
8590 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
8591 }
8592
8593 void
8594 rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8595 {
8596 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
8597 }
8598
8599 static void
8600 rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8601 {
8602 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
8603 }
8604
8605 void
8606 awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
8607 {
8608 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
8609 }
8610
8611 static void
8612 awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
8613 {
8614 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
8615 }
8616 \f
8617
8618 /* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
8619 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
8620
8621 struct until_break_command_continuation_args
8622 {
8623 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8624 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
8625 int thread_num;
8626 };
8627
8628 /* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
8629 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
8630 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
8631 command. */
8632 static void
8633 until_break_command_continuation (void *arg)
8634 {
8635 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
8636
8637 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
8638 if (a->breakpoint2)
8639 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
8640 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
8641 }
8642
8643 void
8644 until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
8645 {
8646 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
8647 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8648 struct frame_info *frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
8649 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
8650 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
8651 struct cleanup *old_chain;
8652 int thread;
8653 struct thread_info *tp;
8654
8655 clear_proceed_status ();
8656
8657 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
8658 this function. */
8659
8660 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
8661 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, default_breakpoint_symtab,
8662 default_breakpoint_line, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8663 else
8664 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL,
8665 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
8666
8667 if (sals.nelts != 1)
8668 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
8669
8670 sal = sals.sals[0];
8671 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
8672
8673 if (*arg)
8674 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8675
8676 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
8677
8678 if (anywhere)
8679 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
8680 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
8681 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8682 null_frame_id, bp_until);
8683 else
8684 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
8685 only at the very same frame. */
8686 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (get_frame_arch (frame), sal,
8687 get_stack_frame_id (frame),
8688 bp_until);
8689
8690 old_chain = make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
8691
8692 tp = inferior_thread ();
8693 thread = tp->num;
8694
8695 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
8696 one. */
8697
8698 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
8699 {
8700 sal = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
8701 sal.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
8702 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
8703 sal,
8704 frame_unwind_caller_id (frame),
8705 bp_until);
8706 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
8707
8708 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, frame_unwind_caller_id (frame));
8709 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
8710 }
8711
8712 proceed (-1, TARGET_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
8713
8714 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
8715 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
8716 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
8717 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
8718
8719 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
8720 {
8721 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
8722 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
8723
8724 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
8725 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
8726 args->thread_num = thread;
8727
8728 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
8729 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
8730 until_break_command_continuation, args,
8731 xfree);
8732 }
8733 else
8734 do_cleanups (old_chain);
8735 }
8736
8737 static void
8738 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (char **s)
8739 {
8740 if ((s == NULL) || (*s == NULL))
8741 return;
8742 while (isspace (**s))
8743 *s += 1;
8744 }
8745
8746 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
8747 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
8748
8749 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
8750 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
8751 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
8752 if clause in the arg string. */
8753
8754 static char *
8755 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
8756 {
8757 char *cond_string;
8758
8759 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
8760 return NULL;
8761
8762 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
8763 (*arg) += 2;
8764
8765 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
8766 condition string. */
8767 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (arg);
8768 cond_string = *arg;
8769
8770 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
8771 string. */
8772 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
8773
8774 return cond_string;
8775 }
8776
8777 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
8778 process start/exit, etc. */
8779
8780 typedef enum
8781 {
8782 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
8783 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
8784 }
8785 catch_fork_kind;
8786
8787 static void
8788 catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8789 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8790 {
8791 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8792 char *cond_string = NULL;
8793 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
8794 int tempflag;
8795
8796 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
8797 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
8798 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
8799
8800 if (!arg)
8801 arg = "";
8802 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8803
8804 /* The allowed syntax is:
8805 catch [v]fork
8806 catch [v]fork if <cond>
8807
8808 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8809 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8810
8811 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8812 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8813
8814 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
8815 and enable reporting of such events. */
8816 switch (fork_kind)
8817 {
8818 case catch_fork_temporary:
8819 case catch_fork_permanent:
8820 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8821 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
8822 break;
8823 case catch_vfork_temporary:
8824 case catch_vfork_permanent:
8825 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8826 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
8827 break;
8828 default:
8829 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
8830 break;
8831 }
8832 }
8833
8834 static void
8835 catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8836 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8837 {
8838 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8839 int tempflag;
8840 char *cond_string = NULL;
8841
8842 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8843
8844 if (!arg)
8845 arg = "";
8846 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8847
8848 /* The allowed syntax is:
8849 catch exec
8850 catch exec if <cond>
8851
8852 First, check if there's an if clause. */
8853 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8854
8855 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
8856 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
8857
8858 /* If this target supports it, create an exec catchpoint
8859 and enable reporting of such events. */
8860 create_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
8861 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
8862 }
8863
8864 static enum print_stop_action
8865 print_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8866 {
8867 int bp_temp, bp_throw;
8868
8869 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8870
8871 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8872 if (b->loc->address != b->loc->requested_address)
8873 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (b->loc->requested_address,
8874 b->loc->address,
8875 b->number, 1);
8876 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8877 ui_out_text (uiout,
8878 bp_temp ? "Temporary catchpoint "
8879 : "Catchpoint ");
8880 if (!ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8881 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8882 ui_out_text (uiout,
8883 bp_throw ? " (exception thrown), "
8884 : " (exception caught), ");
8885 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8886 {
8887 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8888 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
8889 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8890 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8891 }
8892 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8893 }
8894
8895 static void
8896 print_one_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8897 struct bp_location **last_loc)
8898 {
8899 struct value_print_options opts;
8900
8901 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8902 if (opts.addressprint)
8903 {
8904 annotate_field (4);
8905 if (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->shlib_disabled)
8906 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
8907 else
8908 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
8909 b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address);
8910 }
8911 annotate_field (5);
8912 if (b->loc)
8913 *last_loc = b->loc;
8914 if (strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL)
8915 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception throw");
8916 else
8917 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "exception catch");
8918 }
8919
8920 static void
8921 print_mention_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
8922 {
8923 int bp_temp;
8924 int bp_throw;
8925
8926 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8927 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8928 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_temp ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
8929 : _("Catchpoint "));
8930 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8931 ui_out_text (uiout, bp_throw ? _(" (throw)")
8932 : _(" (catch)"));
8933 }
8934
8935 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for throw and
8936 catch catchpoints. */
8937
8938 static void
8939 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8940 struct ui_file *fp)
8941 {
8942 int bp_temp;
8943 int bp_throw;
8944
8945 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
8946 bp_throw = strstr (b->addr_string, "throw") != NULL;
8947 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_temp ? "tcatch " : "catch ");
8948 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, bp_throw ? "throw" : "catch");
8949 }
8950
8951 static struct breakpoint_ops gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops = {
8952 NULL, /* insert */
8953 NULL, /* remove */
8954 NULL, /* breakpoint_hit */
8955 print_exception_catchpoint,
8956 print_one_exception_catchpoint,
8957 print_mention_exception_catchpoint,
8958 print_recreate_exception_catchpoint
8959 };
8960
8961 static int
8962 handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8963 enum exception_event_kind ex_event, int from_tty)
8964 {
8965 char *trigger_func_name;
8966
8967 if (ex_event == EX_EVENT_CATCH)
8968 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_begin_catch";
8969 else
8970 trigger_func_name = "__cxa_throw";
8971
8972 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
8973 trigger_func_name, cond_string, -1,
8974 0 /* condition and thread are valid. */,
8975 tempflag, bp_breakpoint,
8976 0,
8977 AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE /* pending */,
8978 &gnu_v3_exception_catchpoint_ops, from_tty,
8979 1 /* enabled */,
8980 0 /* internal */);
8981
8982 return 1;
8983 }
8984
8985 /* Deal with "catch catch" and "catch throw" commands. */
8986
8987 static void
8988 catch_exception_command_1 (enum exception_event_kind ex_event, char *arg,
8989 int tempflag, int from_tty)
8990 {
8991 char *cond_string = NULL;
8992
8993 if (!arg)
8994 arg = "";
8995 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
8996
8997 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
8998
8999 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
9000 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9001
9002 if (ex_event != EX_EVENT_THROW
9003 && ex_event != EX_EVENT_CATCH)
9004 error (_("Unsupported or unknown exception event; cannot catch it"));
9005
9006 if (handle_gnu_v3_exceptions (tempflag, cond_string, ex_event, from_tty))
9007 return;
9008
9009 warning (_("Unsupported with this platform/compiler combination."));
9010 }
9011
9012 /* Implementation of "catch catch" command. */
9013
9014 static void
9015 catch_catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
9016 {
9017 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9018
9019 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_CATCH, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
9020 }
9021
9022 /* Implementation of "catch throw" command. */
9023
9024 static void
9025 catch_throw_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
9026 {
9027 int tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9028
9029 catch_exception_command_1 (EX_EVENT_THROW, arg, tempflag, from_tty);
9030 }
9031
9032 /* Create a breakpoint struct for Ada exception catchpoints. */
9033
9034 static void
9035 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9036 struct symtab_and_line sal,
9037 char *addr_string,
9038 char *exp_string,
9039 char *cond_string,
9040 struct expression *cond,
9041 struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9042 int tempflag,
9043 int from_tty)
9044 {
9045 struct breakpoint *b;
9046
9047 if (from_tty)
9048 {
9049 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9050 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9051 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9052
9053 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9054 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
9055 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
9056 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
9057 used for different exception names will use the same address.
9058 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
9059 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
9060 inapropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
9061 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
9062 enough for now, though. */
9063 }
9064
9065 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint);
9066 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9067
9068 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9069 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9070 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9071 b->ignore_count = 0;
9072 b->loc->cond = cond;
9073 b->addr_string = addr_string;
9074 b->language = language_ada;
9075 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9076 b->exp_string = exp_string;
9077 b->thread = -1;
9078 b->ops = ops;
9079
9080 mention (b);
9081 update_global_location_list (1);
9082 }
9083
9084 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
9085
9086 static void
9087 catch_ada_exception_command (char *arg, int from_tty,
9088 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9089 {
9090 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9091 int tempflag;
9092 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9093 char *addr_string = NULL;
9094 char *exp_string = NULL;
9095 char *cond_string = NULL;
9096 struct expression *cond = NULL;
9097 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
9098
9099 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9100
9101 if (!arg)
9102 arg = "";
9103 sal = ada_decode_exception_location (arg, &addr_string, &exp_string,
9104 &cond_string, &cond, &ops);
9105 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, exp_string,
9106 cond_string, cond, ops, tempflag,
9107 from_tty);
9108 }
9109
9110 /* Cleanup function for a syscall filter list. */
9111 static void
9112 clean_up_filters (void *arg)
9113 {
9114 VEC(int) *iter = *(VEC(int) **) arg;
9115 VEC_free (int, iter);
9116 }
9117
9118 /* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
9119 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
9120 static VEC(int) *
9121 catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
9122 {
9123 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
9124 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (clean_up_filters, &result);
9125
9126 while (*arg != '\0')
9127 {
9128 int i, syscall_number;
9129 char *endptr;
9130 char cur_name[128];
9131 struct syscall s;
9132
9133 /* Skip whitespace. */
9134 while (isspace (*arg))
9135 arg++;
9136
9137 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
9138 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
9139 cur_name[i] = '\0';
9140 arg += i;
9141
9142 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
9143 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
9144 if (*endptr == '\0')
9145 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
9146 else
9147 {
9148 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
9149 to a number. */
9150 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
9151
9152 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
9153 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning,
9154 because GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no
9155 syscall number to be caught. */
9156 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
9157 }
9158
9159 /* Ok, it's valid. */
9160 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
9161 }
9162
9163 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
9164 return result;
9165 }
9166
9167 /* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
9168
9169 static void
9170 catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
9171 struct cmd_list_element *command)
9172 {
9173 int tempflag;
9174 VEC(int) *filter;
9175 struct syscall s;
9176 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9177
9178 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
9179 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
9180 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
9181 this architeture yet."));
9182
9183 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9184
9185 ep_skip_leading_whitespace (&arg);
9186
9187 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
9188 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
9189 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
9190 for his/her architecture. */
9191 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
9192
9193 /* The allowed syntax is:
9194 catch syscall
9195 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
9196
9197 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
9198
9199 if (arg != NULL)
9200 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
9201 else
9202 filter = NULL;
9203
9204 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
9205 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
9206 }
9207
9208 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
9209
9210 static void
9211 catch_assert_command (char *arg, int from_tty, struct cmd_list_element *command)
9212 {
9213 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
9214 int tempflag;
9215 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9216 char *addr_string = NULL;
9217 struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
9218
9219 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
9220
9221 if (!arg)
9222 arg = "";
9223 sal = ada_decode_assert_location (arg, &addr_string, &ops);
9224 create_ada_exception_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, addr_string, NULL, NULL, NULL,
9225 ops, tempflag, from_tty);
9226 }
9227
9228 static void
9229 catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9230 {
9231 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
9232 }
9233 \f
9234
9235 static void
9236 tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9237 {
9238 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
9239 }
9240
9241 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
9242
9243 static void
9244 clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9245 {
9246 struct breakpoint *b;
9247 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
9248 int ix;
9249 int default_match;
9250 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9251 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9252 int i;
9253
9254 if (arg)
9255 {
9256 sals = decode_line_spec (arg, 1);
9257 default_match = 0;
9258 }
9259 else
9260 {
9261 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
9262 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
9263 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
9264 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9265 sal.line = default_breakpoint_line;
9266 sal.symtab = default_breakpoint_symtab;
9267 sal.pc = default_breakpoint_address;
9268 sal.pspace = default_breakpoint_pspace;
9269 if (sal.symtab == 0)
9270 error (_("No source file specified."));
9271
9272 sals.sals[0] = sal;
9273 sals.nelts = 1;
9274
9275 default_match = 1;
9276 }
9277
9278 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
9279 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
9280 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
9281 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
9282
9283 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
9284 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
9285 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
9286 due to optimization, all in one block.
9287
9288 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
9289 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
9290 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
9291 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
9292 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
9293 to support that. */
9294
9295 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
9296 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
9297 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
9298 breakpoint. */
9299
9300 found = NULL;
9301 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9302 {
9303 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
9304 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
9305 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
9306 or at default pc.
9307
9308 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
9309
9310 0 1 pc
9311 1 1 pc _and_ line
9312 0 0 line
9313 1 0 <can't happen> */
9314
9315 sal = sals.sals[i];
9316
9317 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
9318 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9319 {
9320 int match = 0;
9321 /* Are we going to delete b? */
9322 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
9323 {
9324 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
9325 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
9326 {
9327 int pc_match = sal.pc
9328 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
9329 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
9330 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
9331 || loc->section == sal.section);
9332 int line_match = ((default_match || (0 == sal.pc))
9333 && b->source_file != NULL
9334 && sal.symtab != NULL
9335 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
9336 && strcmp (b->source_file, sal.symtab->filename) == 0
9337 && b->line_number == sal.line);
9338 if (pc_match || line_match)
9339 {
9340 match = 1;
9341 break;
9342 }
9343 }
9344 }
9345
9346 if (match)
9347 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
9348 }
9349 }
9350 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
9351 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
9352 {
9353 if (arg)
9354 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
9355 else
9356 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
9357 }
9358
9359 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
9360 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
9361 if (from_tty)
9362 {
9363 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
9364 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
9365 else
9366 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
9367 }
9368 breakpoints_changed ();
9369
9370 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
9371 {
9372 if (from_tty)
9373 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
9374 delete_breakpoint (b);
9375 }
9376 if (from_tty)
9377 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
9378 }
9379 \f
9380 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
9381 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
9382 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
9383
9384 void
9385 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
9386 {
9387 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
9388
9389 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
9390 if (bs->breakpoint_at
9391 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
9392 && bs->stop)
9393 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
9394
9395 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
9396 {
9397 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
9398 delete_breakpoint (b);
9399 }
9400 }
9401
9402 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
9403 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
9404 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
9405 secondarily by ordering first bp_permanent OWNERed elements and
9406 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
9407 qsort being an instable algorithm. */
9408
9409 static int
9410 bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
9411 {
9412 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
9413 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
9414 /* A and B come from existing breakpoints having non-NULL OWNER. */
9415 int a_perm = a->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9416 int b_perm = b->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent;
9417
9418 if (a->address != b->address)
9419 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
9420
9421 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
9422 if (a_perm != b_perm)
9423 return (a_perm < b_perm) - (a_perm > b_perm);
9424
9425 /* Make the user-visible order stable across GDB runs. Locations of
9426 the same breakpoint can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
9427
9428 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
9429 return (a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
9430 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number);
9431
9432 return (a > b) - (a < b);
9433 }
9434
9435 /* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
9436 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
9437 content of the bp_location array. */
9438
9439 static void
9440 bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
9441 {
9442 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
9443
9444 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
9445 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
9446
9447 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
9448 {
9449 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
9450
9451 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
9452 continue;
9453
9454 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
9455 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
9456
9457 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
9458 addr = bl->address - start;
9459 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
9460 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
9461
9462 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
9463
9464 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
9465 addr = end - bl->address;
9466 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
9467 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
9468 }
9469 }
9470
9471 /* If SHOULD_INSERT is false, do not insert any breakpoint locations
9472 into the inferior, only remove already-inserted locations that no
9473 longer should be inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or
9474 breakpoints should pass false, so that deleting a breakpoint
9475 doesn't have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
9476 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
9477 returns true on them.
9478
9479 This behaviour is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
9480 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but breakpoint
9481 shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* be restored
9482 to the new image; or before detaching, where the target still has
9483 execution and wants to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists, and all
9484 breakpoints had already been removed from the inferior. */
9485
9486 static void
9487 update_global_location_list (int should_insert)
9488 {
9489 struct breakpoint *b;
9490 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
9491 struct cleanup *cleanups;
9492
9493 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
9494 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
9495 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
9496 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
9497 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
9498 once. */
9499 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
9500 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
9501 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
9502 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
9503
9504 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
9505 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
9506 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
9507 unsigned old_location_count;
9508
9509 old_location = bp_location;
9510 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
9511 bp_location = NULL;
9512 bp_location_count = 0;
9513 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
9514
9515 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9516 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9517 bp_location_count++;
9518
9519 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
9520 locp = bp_location;
9521 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9522 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
9523 *locp++ = loc;
9524 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
9525 bp_location_compare);
9526
9527 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
9528
9529 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
9530 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
9531 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
9532 if there's another location at the same address (previously
9533 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
9534 location.
9535
9536 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
9537 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
9538
9539 locp = bp_location;
9540 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
9541 old_locp++)
9542 {
9543 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
9544 struct bp_location **loc2p;
9545
9546 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found amoung the new locations. If
9547 not, we have to free it. */
9548 int found_object = 0;
9549 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
9550 int keep_in_target = 0;
9551 int removed = 0;
9552
9553 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
9554 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
9555 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
9556 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
9557 locp++;
9558
9559 for (loc2p = locp;
9560 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9561 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9562 loc2p++)
9563 {
9564 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
9565 {
9566 found_object = 1;
9567 break;
9568 }
9569 }
9570
9571 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
9572 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
9573 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
9574 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
9575 at certain location is not inserted. */
9576
9577 if (old_loc->inserted)
9578 {
9579 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
9580 it. */
9581
9582 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
9583 {
9584 /* The location is still present in the location list,
9585 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
9586 keep_in_target = 1;
9587 }
9588 else
9589 {
9590 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
9591 disabled. See if there's another location at the
9592 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
9593 this one from the target. */
9594
9595 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
9596 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
9597 {
9598 for (loc2p = locp;
9599 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
9600 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
9601 loc2p++)
9602 {
9603 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
9604
9605 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
9606 {
9607 /* For the sake of should_be_inserted.
9608 Duplicates check below will fix up this
9609 later. */
9610 loc2->duplicate = 0;
9611
9612 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
9613 access watchpoints, if the former are not
9614 supported, but the latter are. */
9615 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9616 {
9617 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
9618 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
9619 }
9620
9621 if (loc2 != old_loc && should_be_inserted (loc2))
9622 {
9623 loc2->inserted = 1;
9624 loc2->target_info = old_loc->target_info;
9625 keep_in_target = 1;
9626 break;
9627 }
9628 }
9629 }
9630 }
9631 }
9632
9633 if (!keep_in_target)
9634 {
9635 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
9636 {
9637 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
9638 this location on the global list, and try to
9639 remove it next time, but there's no particular
9640 reason why we will succeed next time.
9641
9642 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
9643 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
9644 only after calling us. */
9645 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing breakpoint %d\n"),
9646 old_loc->owner->number);
9647 }
9648 removed = 1;
9649 }
9650 }
9651
9652 if (!found_object)
9653 {
9654 if (removed && non_stop
9655 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
9656 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
9657 {
9658 /* This location was removed from the target. In
9659 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
9660 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
9661 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
9662 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
9663 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
9664 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
9665 after we see some number of events. The theory here
9666 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
9667 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
9668 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
9669 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
9670 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
9671 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
9672 SIGTRAP.
9673
9674 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
9675 decr_pc_after_break targets.
9676
9677 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
9678 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
9679 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
9680 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
9681 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
9682 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
9683 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
9684 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
9685 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
9686 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
9687 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
9688 targets that do not support new thread events, like
9689 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
9690 thread_count.
9691
9692 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
9693 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
9694 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
9695 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
9696
9697 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
9698 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
9699 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
9700 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
9701 traps we can no longer explain. */
9702
9703 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
9704 old_loc->owner = NULL;
9705
9706 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
9707 }
9708 else
9709 {
9710 old_loc->owner = NULL;
9711 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
9712 }
9713 }
9714 }
9715
9716 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
9717 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
9718 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
9719 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
9720 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
9721 are sorted first for the same address.
9722
9723 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
9724 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
9725
9726 bp_loc_first = NULL;
9727 wp_loc_first = NULL;
9728 awp_loc_first = NULL;
9729 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
9730 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
9731 {
9732 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
9733 non-NULL. */
9734 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
9735 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
9736
9737 if (b->enable_state == bp_disabled
9738 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled
9739 || b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled
9740 || !loc->enabled
9741 || loc->shlib_disabled
9742 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
9743 || is_tracepoint (b))
9744 continue;
9745
9746 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
9747 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent && ! loc->inserted)
9748 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9749 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
9750 "actually inserted"));
9751
9752 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
9753 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
9754 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
9755 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
9756 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
9757 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
9758 else
9759 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
9760
9761 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
9762 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
9763 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
9764 {
9765 *loc_first_p = loc;
9766 loc->duplicate = 0;
9767 continue;
9768 }
9769
9770 loc->duplicate = 1;
9771
9772 if ((*loc_first_p)->owner->enable_state == bp_permanent && loc->inserted
9773 && b->enable_state != bp_permanent)
9774 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9775 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
9776 "a permanent breakpoint"));
9777 }
9778
9779 if (breakpoints_always_inserted_mode () && should_insert
9780 && (have_live_inferiors ()
9781 || (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch))))
9782 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
9783
9784 do_cleanups (cleanups);
9785 }
9786
9787 void
9788 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
9789 {
9790 struct bp_location *loc;
9791 int ix;
9792
9793 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
9794 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
9795 {
9796 decref_bp_location (&loc);
9797 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
9798 --ix;
9799 }
9800 }
9801
9802 static void
9803 update_global_location_list_nothrow (int inserting)
9804 {
9805 struct gdb_exception e;
9806
9807 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9808 update_global_location_list (inserting);
9809 }
9810
9811 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
9812
9813 static void
9814 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
9815 {
9816 bpstat bs;
9817
9818 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
9819 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
9820 {
9821 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
9822 bs->old_val = NULL;
9823 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
9824 }
9825 }
9826
9827 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
9828 static int
9829 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
9830 {
9831 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
9832
9833 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
9834 return 0;
9835 }
9836
9837 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
9838 structures. */
9839
9840 void
9841 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
9842 {
9843 struct breakpoint *b;
9844
9845 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
9846
9847 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
9848 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
9849 especial culprits.
9850
9851 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
9852 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
9853 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
9854 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
9855 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
9856 deleted.
9857
9858 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
9859 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
9860 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
9861 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
9862 was chosen. */
9863 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
9864 return;
9865
9866 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
9867 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
9868 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != NULL)
9869 {
9870 gdb_assert (bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == bpt);
9871 bpt->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
9872 bpt->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9873 bpt->related_breakpoint = NULL;
9874 }
9875
9876 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt->number);
9877
9878 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
9879 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
9880
9881 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9882 if (b->next == bpt)
9883 {
9884 b->next = bpt->next;
9885 break;
9886 }
9887
9888 decref_counted_command_line (&bpt->commands);
9889 xfree (bpt->cond_string);
9890 xfree (bpt->cond_exp);
9891 xfree (bpt->addr_string);
9892 xfree (bpt->exp);
9893 xfree (bpt->exp_string);
9894 xfree (bpt->exp_string_reparse);
9895 value_free (bpt->val);
9896 xfree (bpt->source_file);
9897 xfree (bpt->exec_pathname);
9898 clean_up_filters (&bpt->syscalls_to_be_caught);
9899
9900
9901 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
9902 been freed. */
9903 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
9904 in all threeds for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
9905 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
9906 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
9907 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
9908 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
9909 commands won't work. */
9910
9911 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
9912
9913 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
9914 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
9915 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
9916 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
9917 might be better design to have location completely
9918 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
9919 update_global_location_list (0);
9920
9921
9922 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
9923 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
9924 bpt->type = bp_none;
9925
9926 xfree (bpt);
9927 }
9928
9929 static void
9930 do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
9931 {
9932 delete_breakpoint (b);
9933 }
9934
9935 struct cleanup *
9936 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9937 {
9938 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
9939 }
9940
9941 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
9942 delete_breakpoint. */
9943
9944 static void
9945 do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
9946 {
9947 delete_breakpoint (b);
9948 }
9949
9950 void
9951 delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
9952 {
9953 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
9954
9955 dont_repeat ();
9956
9957 if (arg == 0)
9958 {
9959 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
9960
9961 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
9962 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these have
9963 to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */
9964 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9965 {
9966 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9967 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
9968 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9969 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9970 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9971 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9972 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9973 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
9974 && b->type != bp_exception_master
9975 && b->number >= 0)
9976 {
9977 breaks_to_delete = 1;
9978 break;
9979 }
9980 }
9981
9982 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
9983 if (!from_tty
9984 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
9985 {
9986 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
9987 {
9988 if (b->type != bp_call_dummy
9989 && b->type != bp_std_terminate
9990 && b->type != bp_shlib_event
9991 && b->type != bp_thread_event
9992 && b->type != bp_jit_event
9993 && b->type != bp_overlay_event
9994 && b->type != bp_longjmp_master
9995 && b->type != bp_std_terminate_master
9996 && b->type != bp_exception_master
9997 && b->number >= 0)
9998 delete_breakpoint (b);
9999 }
10000 }
10001 }
10002 else
10003 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
10004 }
10005
10006 static int
10007 all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
10008 {
10009 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
10010 if (!loc->shlib_disabled)
10011 return 0;
10012 return 1;
10013 }
10014
10015 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
10016 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
10017 Null names are ignored. */
10018
10019 static int
10020 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
10021 {
10022 struct bp_location *l;
10023 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
10024 (int (*) (const void *,
10025 const void *)) streq,
10026 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
10027
10028 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
10029 {
10030 const char **slot;
10031 const char *name = l->function_name;
10032
10033 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
10034 if (name == NULL)
10035 continue;
10036
10037 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
10038 INSERT);
10039 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
10040 returns NULL. */
10041 if (*slot != NULL)
10042 {
10043 htab_delete (htab);
10044 return 1;
10045 }
10046 *slot = name;
10047 }
10048
10049 htab_delete (htab);
10050 return 0;
10051 }
10052
10053 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
10054 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
10055 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
10056 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
10057 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
10058 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
10059 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
10060 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
10061 The heuristic is:
10062
10063 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
10064 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
10065 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
10066 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
10067 in the sources, and output a warning.
10068
10069 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
10070 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
10071 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
10072 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
10073 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
10074 warning.
10075
10076 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
10077 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
10078 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
10079 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
10080 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
10081 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
10082 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
10083 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
10084 precisely because it confuses tools). */
10085
10086 static struct symtab_and_line
10087 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
10088 {
10089 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
10090 CORE_ADDR pc;
10091 int i;
10092
10093 pc = sal.pc;
10094 if (sal.line)
10095 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
10096
10097 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
10098 {
10099 if (strcmp (b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
10100 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
10101 b->number,
10102 b->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
10103
10104 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10105 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
10106 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
10107
10108 return sal;
10109 }
10110
10111 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
10112 by string ID. */
10113 if (!sal.explicit_pc
10114 && sal.line != 0
10115 && sal.symtab != NULL
10116 && b->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
10117 {
10118 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
10119
10120 markers
10121 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10122
10123 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
10124 {
10125 struct symtab_and_line sal;
10126 struct symbol *sym;
10127 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
10128
10129 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
10130
10131 xfree (b->static_trace_marker_id);
10132 b->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker->str_id);
10133
10134 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
10135 "found at previous line number"),
10136 b->number, b->static_trace_marker_id);
10137
10138 init_sal (&sal);
10139
10140 sal.pc = marker->address;
10141
10142 sal = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
10143 sym = find_pc_sect_function (marker->address, NULL);
10144 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
10145 if (sym)
10146 {
10147 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
10148 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
10149 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
10150 }
10151 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file", sal.symtab->filename);
10152 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
10153
10154 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10155 {
10156 char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
10157
10158 if (fullname)
10159 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
10160 }
10161
10162 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal.line);
10163 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10164
10165 b->line_number = sal.line;
10166
10167 xfree (b->source_file);
10168 if (sym)
10169 b->source_file = xstrdup (sal.symtab->filename);
10170 else
10171 b->source_file = NULL;
10172
10173 xfree (b->addr_string);
10174 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
10175 sal.symtab->filename, b->line_number);
10176
10177 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
10178 so. */
10179
10180 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
10181 }
10182 }
10183 return sal;
10184 }
10185
10186 static void
10187 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
10188 struct symtabs_and_lines sals)
10189 {
10190 int i;
10191 char *s;
10192 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
10193
10194 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
10195 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
10196 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
10197 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
10198 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
10199 individual locations. */
10200 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
10201 return;
10202
10203 b->loc = NULL;
10204
10205 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
10206 {
10207 struct bp_location *new_loc =
10208 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
10209
10210 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
10211 old symtab. */
10212 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
10213 {
10214 struct gdb_exception e;
10215
10216 s = b->cond_string;
10217 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10218 {
10219 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
10220 0);
10221 }
10222 if (e.reason < 0)
10223 {
10224 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition for breakpoint %d: %s"),
10225 b->number, e.message);
10226 new_loc->enabled = 0;
10227 }
10228 }
10229
10230 if (b->source_file != NULL)
10231 xfree (b->source_file);
10232 if (sals.sals[i].symtab == NULL)
10233 b->source_file = NULL;
10234 else
10235 b->source_file = xstrdup (sals.sals[i].symtab->filename);
10236
10237 if (b->line_number == 0)
10238 b->line_number = sals.sals[i].line;
10239 }
10240
10241 /* Update locations of permanent breakpoints. */
10242 if (b->enable_state == bp_permanent)
10243 make_breakpoint_permanent (b);
10244
10245 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
10246 breakpoints. */
10247 {
10248 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
10249 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
10250 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
10251 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
10252 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
10253 often enough until a better solution is found. */
10254 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
10255
10256 for (; e; e = e->next)
10257 {
10258 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
10259 {
10260 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
10261 if (have_ambiguous_names)
10262 {
10263 for (; l; l = l->next)
10264 if (breakpoint_address_match (e->pspace->aspace, e->address,
10265 l->pspace->aspace, l->address))
10266 {
10267 l->enabled = 0;
10268 break;
10269 }
10270 }
10271 else
10272 {
10273 for (; l; l = l->next)
10274 if (l->function_name
10275 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
10276 {
10277 l->enabled = 0;
10278 break;
10279 }
10280 }
10281 }
10282 }
10283 }
10284
10285 update_global_location_list (1);
10286 }
10287
10288 /* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
10289 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
10290 Unused in this case. */
10291
10292 static int
10293 breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
10294 {
10295 /* Get past catch_errs. */
10296 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
10297 int not_found = 0;
10298 int *not_found_ptr = &not_found;
10299 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
10300 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
10301 char *s;
10302 struct gdb_exception e;
10303 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
10304 int marker_spec = 0;
10305
10306 switch (b->type)
10307 {
10308 case bp_none:
10309 warning (_("attempted to reset apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10310 b->number);
10311 return 0;
10312 case bp_breakpoint:
10313 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10314 case bp_tracepoint:
10315 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10316 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10317 /* Do not attempt to re-set breakpoints disabled during startup. */
10318 if (b->enable_state == bp_startup_disabled)
10319 return 0;
10320
10321 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
10322 {
10323 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
10324 delete_breakpoint (b);
10325 return 0;
10326 }
10327
10328 input_radix = b->input_radix;
10329 s = b->addr_string;
10330
10331 save_current_space_and_thread ();
10332 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
10333
10334 marker_spec = b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && is_marker_spec (s);
10335
10336 set_language (b->language);
10337 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
10338 {
10339 if (marker_spec)
10340 {
10341 sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
10342 if (sals.nelts > b->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
10343 {
10344 sals.sals[0] = sals.sals[b->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
10345 sals.nelts = 1;
10346 }
10347 else
10348 error (_("marker %s not found"), b->static_trace_marker_id);
10349 }
10350 else
10351 sals = decode_line_1 (&s, 1, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL,
10352 not_found_ptr);
10353 }
10354 if (e.reason < 0)
10355 {
10356 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
10357 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
10358 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
10359 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
10360 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
10361 state, then user already saw the message about that
10362 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
10363 errors. */
10364 if (not_found
10365 && (b->condition_not_parsed
10366 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
10367 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
10368 not_found_and_ok = 1;
10369
10370 if (!not_found_and_ok)
10371 {
10372 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
10373 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
10374 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
10375 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
10376 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
10377 which approach is better. */
10378 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10379 throw_exception (e);
10380 }
10381 }
10382
10383 if (!not_found)
10384 {
10385 gdb_assert (sals.nelts == 1);
10386
10387 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[0]);
10388 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
10389 {
10390 char *cond_string = 0;
10391 int thread = -1;
10392 int task = 0;
10393
10394 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
10395 &cond_string, &thread, &task);
10396 if (cond_string)
10397 b->cond_string = cond_string;
10398 b->thread = thread;
10399 b->task = task;
10400 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
10401 }
10402
10403 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !marker_spec)
10404 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
10405
10406 expanded = expand_line_sal_maybe (sals.sals[0]);
10407 }
10408
10409 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
10410 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded);
10411 break;
10412
10413 case bp_watchpoint:
10414 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10415 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10416 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10417 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10418 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10419
10420 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and
10421 even persist across program restarts. Since they can use
10422 variables from shared libraries, we need to reparse
10423 expression as libraries are loaded and unloaded.
10424
10425 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as
10426 result of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses
10427 both a local and a global variables in expression, it's a
10428 local watchpoint, but unloading of a shared library will make
10429 the expression invalid. This is not a very common use case,
10430 but we still re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to
10431 the user.
10432
10433 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10434 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means
10435 the watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In
10436 fact, I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10437
10438 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10439 b->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10440
10441 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will
10442 be reevaluated again when enabled. */
10443 update_watchpoint (b, 1 /* reparse */);
10444 break;
10445 /* We needn't really do anything to reset these, since the mask
10446 that requests them is unaffected by e.g., new libraries being
10447 loaded. */
10448 case bp_catchpoint:
10449 break;
10450
10451 default:
10452 printf_filtered (_("Deleting unknown breakpoint type %d\n"), b->type);
10453 /* fall through */
10454 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they will be
10455 reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
10456 case bp_overlay_event:
10457 case bp_longjmp_master:
10458 case bp_std_terminate_master:
10459 case bp_exception_master:
10460 delete_breakpoint (b);
10461 break;
10462
10463 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
10464 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
10465 case bp_shlib_event:
10466
10467 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special.
10468 Once it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
10469 case bp_thread_event:
10470
10471 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we
10472 step over a dlopen call and SOLIB_ADD is resetting the
10473 breakpoints. Otherwise these should have been blown away via
10474 the cleanup chain or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we
10475 rerun the executable. */
10476 case bp_until:
10477 case bp_finish:
10478 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
10479 case bp_call_dummy:
10480 case bp_std_terminate:
10481 case bp_step_resume:
10482 case bp_longjmp:
10483 case bp_longjmp_resume:
10484 case bp_exception:
10485 case bp_exception_resume:
10486 case bp_jit_event:
10487 break;
10488 }
10489
10490 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10491 return 0;
10492 }
10493
10494 /* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
10495 void
10496 breakpoint_re_set (void)
10497 {
10498 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
10499 enum language save_language;
10500 int save_input_radix;
10501 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10502
10503 save_language = current_language->la_language;
10504 save_input_radix = input_radix;
10505 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
10506
10507 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
10508 {
10509 /* Format possible error msg. */
10510 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
10511 b->number);
10512 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
10513 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
10514 do_cleanups (cleanups);
10515 }
10516 set_language (save_language);
10517 input_radix = save_input_radix;
10518
10519 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
10520
10521 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10522
10523 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ("_ovly_debug_event");
10524 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("longjmp");
10525 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_longjmp");
10526 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("siglongjmp");
10527 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ("_siglongjmp");
10528 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ("std::terminate()");
10529 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
10530 }
10531 \f
10532 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
10533
10534 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
10535 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
10536 void
10537 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
10538 {
10539 if (b->thread != -1)
10540 {
10541 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
10542 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
10543
10544 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
10545 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
10546 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
10547 as well. */
10548 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
10549 }
10550 }
10551
10552 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10553 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10554 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10555
10556 void
10557 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
10558 {
10559 struct breakpoint *b;
10560
10561 if (count < 0)
10562 count = 0;
10563
10564 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10565 if (b->number == bptnum)
10566 {
10567 if (is_tracepoint (b))
10568 {
10569 if (from_tty && count != 0)
10570 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
10571 bptnum);
10572 return;
10573 }
10574
10575 b->ignore_count = count;
10576 if (from_tty)
10577 {
10578 if (count == 0)
10579 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time breakpoint %d is reached."),
10580 bptnum);
10581 else if (count == 1)
10582 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
10583 bptnum);
10584 else
10585 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d crossings of breakpoint %d."),
10586 count, bptnum);
10587 }
10588 breakpoints_changed ();
10589 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b->number);
10590 return;
10591 }
10592
10593 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
10594 }
10595
10596 void
10597 make_breakpoint_silent (struct breakpoint *b)
10598 {
10599 /* Silence the breakpoint. */
10600 b->silent = 1;
10601 }
10602
10603 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
10604
10605 static void
10606 ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10607 {
10608 char *p = args;
10609 int num;
10610
10611 if (p == 0)
10612 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
10613
10614 num = get_number (&p);
10615 if (num == 0)
10616 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
10617 if (*p == 0)
10618 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
10619
10620 set_ignore_count (num,
10621 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
10622 from_tty);
10623 if (from_tty)
10624 printf_filtered ("\n");
10625 }
10626 \f
10627 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
10628 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
10629
10630 static void
10631 map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
10632 void *),
10633 void *data)
10634 {
10635 char *p = args;
10636 char *p1;
10637 int num;
10638 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
10639 int match;
10640
10641 if (p == 0)
10642 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
10643
10644 while (*p)
10645 {
10646 match = 0;
10647 p1 = p;
10648
10649 num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10650 if (num == 0)
10651 {
10652 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
10653 }
10654 else
10655 {
10656 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
10657 if (b->number == num)
10658 {
10659 struct breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
10660 match = 1;
10661 function (b, data);
10662 if (related_breakpoint)
10663 function (related_breakpoint, data);
10664 break;
10665 }
10666 if (match == 0)
10667 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
10668 }
10669 p = p1;
10670 }
10671 }
10672
10673 static struct bp_location *
10674 find_location_by_number (char *number)
10675 {
10676 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
10677 char *p1;
10678 int bp_num;
10679 int loc_num;
10680 struct breakpoint *b;
10681 struct bp_location *loc;
10682
10683 *dot = '\0';
10684
10685 p1 = number;
10686 bp_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10687 if (bp_num == 0)
10688 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10689
10690 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
10691 if (b->number == bp_num)
10692 {
10693 break;
10694 }
10695
10696 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
10697 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
10698
10699 p1 = dot+1;
10700 loc_num = get_number_or_range (&p1);
10701 if (loc_num == 0)
10702 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
10703
10704 --loc_num;
10705 loc = b->loc;
10706 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
10707 ;
10708 if (!loc)
10709 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
10710
10711 return loc;
10712 }
10713
10714
10715 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
10716 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
10717 which ends with a period (no newline). */
10718
10719 void
10720 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10721 {
10722 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
10723 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
10724 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
10725 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
10726 return;
10727
10728 /* You can't disable permanent breakpoints. */
10729 if (bpt->enable_state == bp_permanent)
10730 return;
10731
10732 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
10733
10734 update_global_location_list (0);
10735
10736 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
10737 }
10738
10739 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10740 disable_breakpoint. */
10741
10742 static void
10743 do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10744 {
10745 disable_breakpoint (b);
10746 }
10747
10748 static void
10749 disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10750 {
10751 struct breakpoint *bpt;
10752
10753 if (args == 0)
10754 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
10755 switch (bpt->type)
10756 {
10757 case bp_none:
10758 warning (_("attempted to disable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10759 bpt->number);
10760 continue;
10761 case bp_breakpoint:
10762 case bp_tracepoint:
10763 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10764 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10765 case bp_catchpoint:
10766 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10767 case bp_watchpoint:
10768 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10769 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10770 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10771 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
10772 default:
10773 continue;
10774 }
10775 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
10776 {
10777 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
10778 if (loc)
10779 loc->enabled = 0;
10780 update_global_location_list (0);
10781 }
10782 else
10783 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
10784 }
10785
10786 static void
10787 do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition)
10788 {
10789 int target_resources_ok;
10790
10791 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
10792 {
10793 int i;
10794 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10795 target_resources_ok =
10796 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10797 i + 1, 0);
10798 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
10799 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
10800 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
10801 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10802 }
10803
10804 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
10805 {
10806 struct gdb_exception e;
10807
10808 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
10809 {
10810 update_watchpoint (bpt, 1 /* reparse */);
10811 }
10812 if (e.reason < 0)
10813 {
10814 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
10815 bpt->number);
10816 return;
10817 }
10818 }
10819
10820 if (bpt->enable_state != bp_permanent)
10821 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10822 bpt->disposition = disposition;
10823 update_global_location_list (1);
10824 breakpoints_changed ();
10825
10826 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt->number);
10827 }
10828
10829
10830 void
10831 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
10832 {
10833 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, bpt->disposition);
10834 }
10835
10836 /* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
10837 enable_breakpoint. */
10838
10839 static void
10840 do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
10841 {
10842 enable_breakpoint (b);
10843 }
10844
10845 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
10846 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
10847 in stopping the inferior. */
10848
10849 static void
10850 enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10851 {
10852 struct breakpoint *bpt;
10853
10854 if (args == 0)
10855 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
10856 switch (bpt->type)
10857 {
10858 case bp_none:
10859 warning (_("attempted to enable apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
10860 bpt->number);
10861 continue;
10862 case bp_breakpoint:
10863 case bp_tracepoint:
10864 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
10865 case bp_static_tracepoint:
10866 case bp_catchpoint:
10867 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
10868 case bp_watchpoint:
10869 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10870 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10871 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10872 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
10873 default:
10874 continue;
10875 }
10876 else if (strchr (args, '.'))
10877 {
10878 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (args);
10879 if (loc)
10880 loc->enabled = 1;
10881 update_global_location_list (1);
10882 }
10883 else
10884 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
10885 }
10886
10887 static void
10888 enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
10889 {
10890 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_disable);
10891 }
10892
10893 static void
10894 enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10895 {
10896 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
10897 }
10898
10899 static void
10900 enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
10901 {
10902 do_enable_breakpoint (bpt, disp_del);
10903 }
10904
10905 static void
10906 enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
10907 {
10908 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
10909 }
10910 \f
10911 static void
10912 set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
10913 {
10914 }
10915
10916 static void
10917 show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
10918 {
10919 }
10920
10921 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
10922 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
10923 GDB itself. */
10924
10925 static void
10926 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (CORE_ADDR addr, int len,
10927 const bfd_byte *data)
10928 {
10929 struct breakpoint *bp;
10930
10931 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
10932 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
10933 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
10934 && bp->val_valid && bp->val)
10935 {
10936 struct bp_location *loc;
10937
10938 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
10939 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
10940 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
10941 && addr + len > loc->address)
10942 {
10943 value_free (bp->val);
10944 bp->val = NULL;
10945 bp->val_valid = 0;
10946 }
10947 }
10948 }
10949
10950 /* Use default_breakpoint_'s, or nothing if they aren't valid. */
10951
10952 struct symtabs_and_lines
10953 decode_line_spec_1 (char *string, int funfirstline)
10954 {
10955 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
10956
10957 if (string == 0)
10958 error (_("Empty line specification."));
10959 if (default_breakpoint_valid)
10960 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
10961 default_breakpoint_symtab,
10962 default_breakpoint_line,
10963 (char ***) NULL, NULL);
10964 else
10965 sals = decode_line_1 (&string, funfirstline,
10966 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0, (char ***) NULL, NULL);
10967 if (*string)
10968 error (_("Junk at end of line specification: %s"), string);
10969 return sals;
10970 }
10971
10972 /* Create and insert a raw software breakpoint at PC. Return an
10973 identifier, which should be used to remove the breakpoint later.
10974 In general, places which call this should be using something on the
10975 breakpoint chain instead; this function should be eliminated
10976 someday. */
10977
10978 void *
10979 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
10980 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
10981 {
10982 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt;
10983
10984 bp_tgt = XZALLOC (struct bp_target_info);
10985
10986 bp_tgt->placed_address_space = aspace;
10987 bp_tgt->placed_address = pc;
10988
10989 if (target_insert_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt) != 0)
10990 {
10991 /* Could not insert the breakpoint. */
10992 xfree (bp_tgt);
10993 return NULL;
10994 }
10995
10996 return bp_tgt;
10997 }
10998
10999 /* Remove a breakpoint BP inserted by
11000 deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint. */
11001
11002 int
11003 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, void *bp)
11004 {
11005 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = bp;
11006 int ret;
11007
11008 ret = target_remove_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_tgt);
11009 xfree (bp_tgt);
11010
11011 return ret;
11012 }
11013
11014 /* One (or perhaps two) breakpoints used for software single
11015 stepping. */
11016
11017 static void *single_step_breakpoints[2];
11018 static struct gdbarch *single_step_gdbarch[2];
11019
11020 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
11021
11022 void
11023 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11024 struct address_space *aspace,
11025 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
11026 {
11027 void **bpt_p;
11028
11029 if (single_step_breakpoints[0] == NULL)
11030 {
11031 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[0];
11032 single_step_gdbarch[0] = gdbarch;
11033 }
11034 else
11035 {
11036 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[1] == NULL);
11037 bpt_p = &single_step_breakpoints[1];
11038 single_step_gdbarch[1] = gdbarch;
11039 }
11040
11041 /* NOTE drow/2006-04-11: A future improvement to this function would
11042 be to only create the breakpoints once, and actually put them on
11043 the breakpoint chain. That would let us use set_raw_breakpoint.
11044 We could adjust the addresses each time they were needed. Doing
11045 this requires corresponding changes elsewhere where single step
11046 breakpoints are handled, however. So, for now, we use this. */
11047
11048 *bpt_p = deprecated_insert_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, next_pc);
11049 if (*bpt_p == NULL)
11050 error (_("Could not insert single-step breakpoint at %s"),
11051 paddress (gdbarch, next_pc));
11052 }
11053
11054 /* Check if the breakpoints used for software single stepping
11055 were inserted or not. */
11056
11057 int
11058 single_step_breakpoints_inserted (void)
11059 {
11060 return (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL
11061 || single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL);
11062 }
11063
11064 /* Remove and delete any breakpoints used for software single step. */
11065
11066 void
11067 remove_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11068 {
11069 gdb_assert (single_step_breakpoints[0] != NULL);
11070
11071 /* See insert_single_step_breakpoint for more about this deprecated
11072 call. */
11073 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[0],
11074 single_step_breakpoints[0]);
11075 single_step_gdbarch[0] = NULL;
11076 single_step_breakpoints[0] = NULL;
11077
11078 if (single_step_breakpoints[1] != NULL)
11079 {
11080 deprecated_remove_raw_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[1],
11081 single_step_breakpoints[1]);
11082 single_step_gdbarch[1] = NULL;
11083 single_step_breakpoints[1] = NULL;
11084 }
11085 }
11086
11087 /* Delete software single step breakpoints without removing them from
11088 the inferior. This is intended to be used if the inferior's address
11089 space where they were inserted is already gone, e.g. after exit or
11090 exec. */
11091
11092 void
11093 cancel_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11094 {
11095 int i;
11096
11097 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11098 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
11099 {
11100 xfree (single_step_breakpoints[i]);
11101 single_step_breakpoints[i] = NULL;
11102 single_step_gdbarch[i] = NULL;
11103 }
11104 }
11105
11106 /* Detach software single-step breakpoints from INFERIOR_PTID without
11107 removing them. */
11108
11109 static void
11110 detach_single_step_breakpoints (void)
11111 {
11112 int i;
11113
11114 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11115 if (single_step_breakpoints[i])
11116 target_remove_breakpoint (single_step_gdbarch[i],
11117 single_step_breakpoints[i]);
11118 }
11119
11120 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
11121 PC. */
11122
11123 static int
11124 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
11125 CORE_ADDR pc)
11126 {
11127 int i;
11128
11129 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11130 {
11131 struct bp_target_info *bp_tgt = single_step_breakpoints[i];
11132 if (bp_tgt
11133 && breakpoint_address_match (bp_tgt->placed_address_space,
11134 bp_tgt->placed_address,
11135 aspace, pc))
11136 return 1;
11137 }
11138
11139 return 0;
11140 }
11141
11142 /* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
11143 non-zero otherwise. */
11144 static int
11145 is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
11146 {
11147 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
11148 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
11149 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
11150 return 1;
11151 else
11152 return 0;
11153 }
11154
11155 int
11156 catch_syscall_enabled (void)
11157 {
11158 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
11159
11160 return inf->total_syscalls_count != 0;
11161 }
11162
11163 int
11164 catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
11165 {
11166 struct breakpoint *bp;
11167
11168 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
11169 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
11170 {
11171 if (bp->syscalls_to_be_caught)
11172 {
11173 int i, iter;
11174 for (i = 0;
11175 VEC_iterate (int, bp->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
11176 i++)
11177 if (syscall_number == iter)
11178 return 1;
11179 }
11180 else
11181 return 1;
11182 }
11183
11184 return 0;
11185 }
11186
11187 /* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
11188 static char **
11189 catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
11190 char *text, char *word)
11191 {
11192 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
11193
11194 return (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, text, word);
11195 }
11196
11197 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
11198
11199 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
11200 static void
11201 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
11202 {
11203 tracepoint_count = num;
11204 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
11205 }
11206
11207 void
11208 trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11209 {
11210 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11211 arg,
11212 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11213 0 /* tempflag */,
11214 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11215 0 /* Ignore count */,
11216 pending_break_support,
11217 NULL,
11218 from_tty,
11219 1 /* enabled */,
11220 0 /* internal */))
11221 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11222 }
11223
11224 void
11225 ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11226 {
11227 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11228 arg,
11229 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11230 0 /* tempflag */,
11231 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11232 0 /* Ignore count */,
11233 pending_break_support,
11234 NULL,
11235 from_tty,
11236 1 /* enabled */,
11237 0 /* internal */))
11238 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11239 }
11240
11241 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
11242
11243 void
11244 strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11245 {
11246 if (create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11247 arg,
11248 NULL, 0, 1 /* parse arg */,
11249 0 /* tempflag */,
11250 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
11251 0 /* Ignore count */,
11252 pending_break_support,
11253 NULL,
11254 from_tty,
11255 1 /* enabled */,
11256 0 /* internal */))
11257 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11258 }
11259
11260 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
11261 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
11262
11263 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
11264 static int next_cmd;
11265
11266 static char *
11267 read_uploaded_action (void)
11268 {
11269 char *rslt;
11270
11271 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
11272
11273 next_cmd++;
11274
11275 return rslt;
11276 }
11277
11278 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
11279 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
11280 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
11281 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
11282 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
11283
11284 struct breakpoint *
11285 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
11286 {
11287 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
11288 struct breakpoint *tp;
11289
11290 if (utp->at_string)
11291 addr_str = utp->at_string;
11292 else
11293 {
11294 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
11295 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
11296 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
11297 user. */
11298 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no source location, using raw address"),
11299 utp->number);
11300 sprintf (small_buf, "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
11301 addr_str = small_buf;
11302 }
11303
11304 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
11305 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
11306 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition has no source form, ignoring it"),
11307 utp->number);
11308
11309 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
11310 addr_str,
11311 utp->cond_string, -1, 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
11312 0 /* tempflag */,
11313 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
11314 0 /* Ignore count */,
11315 pending_break_support,
11316 NULL,
11317 0 /* from_tty */,
11318 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
11319 0 /* internal */))
11320 return NULL;
11321
11322 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
11323
11324 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
11325 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
11326 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
11327
11328 if (utp->pass > 0)
11329 {
11330 sprintf (small_buf, "%d %d", utp->pass, tp->number);
11331
11332 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
11333 }
11334
11335 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
11336 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
11337 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
11338 function. */
11339 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
11340 {
11341 struct command_line *cmd_list;
11342
11343 this_utp = utp;
11344 next_cmd = 0;
11345
11346 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
11347
11348 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, cmd_list);
11349 }
11350 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
11351 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
11352 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions have no source form, ignoring them"),
11353 utp->number);
11354
11355 return tp;
11356 }
11357
11358 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
11359 omitted. */
11360
11361 static void
11362 tracepoints_info (char *tpnum_exp, int from_tty)
11363 {
11364 int tpnum = -1, num_printed;
11365
11366 if (tpnum_exp)
11367 tpnum = parse_and_eval_long (tpnum_exp);
11368
11369 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (tpnum, 0, is_tracepoint);
11370
11371 if (num_printed == 0)
11372 {
11373 if (tpnum == -1)
11374 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
11375 else
11376 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
11377 }
11378
11379 default_collect_info ();
11380 }
11381
11382 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
11383 Not supported by all targets. */
11384 static void
11385 enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11386 {
11387 enable_command (args, from_tty);
11388 }
11389
11390 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
11391 Not supported by all targets. */
11392 static void
11393 disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11394 {
11395 disable_command (args, from_tty);
11396 }
11397
11398 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
11399 static void
11400 delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11401 {
11402 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11403
11404 dont_repeat ();
11405
11406 if (arg == 0)
11407 {
11408 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
11409
11410 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
11411 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
11412 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
11413 argument. */
11414 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11415 {
11416 if (b->number >= 0)
11417 {
11418 breaks_to_delete = 1;
11419 break;
11420 }
11421 }
11422
11423 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
11424 if (!from_tty
11425 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
11426 {
11427 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11428 {
11429 if (is_tracepoint (b)
11430 && b->number >= 0)
11431 delete_breakpoint (b);
11432 }
11433 }
11434 }
11435 else
11436 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
11437 }
11438
11439 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
11440
11441 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
11442 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
11443 Also accepts special argument "all". */
11444
11445 static void
11446 trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11447 {
11448 struct breakpoint *t1 = (struct breakpoint *) -1, *t2;
11449 unsigned int count;
11450 int all = 0;
11451
11452 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
11453 error (_("passcount command requires an argument (count + optional TP num)"));
11454
11455 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
11456
11457 while (*args && isspace ((int) *args))
11458 args++;
11459
11460 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
11461 {
11462 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
11463 all = 1;
11464 if (*args)
11465 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11466 }
11467 else
11468 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 1);
11469
11470 do
11471 {
11472 if (t1)
11473 {
11474 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t2)
11475 if (t1 == (struct breakpoint *) -1 || t1 == t2)
11476 {
11477 t2->pass_count = count;
11478 observer_notify_tracepoint_modified (t2->number);
11479 if (from_tty)
11480 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
11481 t2->number, count);
11482 }
11483 if (! all && *args)
11484 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, 1, 0);
11485 }
11486 }
11487 while (*args);
11488 }
11489
11490 struct breakpoint *
11491 get_tracepoint (int num)
11492 {
11493 struct breakpoint *t;
11494
11495 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11496 if (t->number == num)
11497 return t;
11498
11499 return NULL;
11500 }
11501
11502 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
11503 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
11504 reconnecting). */
11505
11506 struct breakpoint *
11507 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
11508 {
11509 struct breakpoint *t;
11510
11511 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11512 if (t->number_on_target == num)
11513 return t;
11514
11515 return NULL;
11516 }
11517
11518 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
11519 If MULTI_P is true, there might be a range of tracepoints in ARG.
11520 if OPTIONAL_P is true, then if the argument is missing, the most
11521 recent tracepoint (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
11522 struct breakpoint *
11523 get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg, int multi_p, int optional_p)
11524 {
11525 extern int tracepoint_count;
11526 struct breakpoint *t;
11527 int tpnum;
11528 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
11529
11530 if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
11531 {
11532 if (optional_p)
11533 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
11534 else
11535 error_no_arg (_("tracepoint number"));
11536 }
11537 else
11538 tpnum = multi_p ? get_number_or_range (arg) : get_number (arg);
11539
11540 if (tpnum <= 0)
11541 {
11542 if (instring && *instring)
11543 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
11544 instring);
11545 else
11546 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint argument missing and no previous tracepoint\n"));
11547 return NULL;
11548 }
11549
11550 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
11551 if (t->number == tpnum)
11552 {
11553 return t;
11554 }
11555
11556 /* FIXME: if we are in the middle of a range we don't want to give
11557 a message. The current interface to get_number_or_range doesn't
11558 allow us to discover this. */
11559 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
11560 return NULL;
11561 }
11562
11563 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
11564 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
11565 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
11566 non-zero. */
11567
11568 static void
11569 save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
11570 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
11571 {
11572 struct breakpoint *tp;
11573 int any = 0;
11574 char *pathname;
11575 struct cleanup *cleanup;
11576 struct ui_file *fp;
11577 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
11578
11579 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
11580 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
11581
11582 /* See if we have anything to save. */
11583 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11584 {
11585 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11586 if (!user_settable_breakpoint (tp) || tp->number < 0)
11587 continue;
11588
11589 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11590 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11591 continue;
11592
11593 any = 1;
11594
11595 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
11596 {
11597 extra_trace_bits = 1;
11598
11599 /* We can stop searching. */
11600 break;
11601 }
11602 }
11603
11604 if (!any)
11605 {
11606 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
11607 return;
11608 }
11609
11610 pathname = tilde_expand (filename);
11611 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, pathname);
11612 fp = gdb_fopen (pathname, "w");
11613 if (!fp)
11614 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
11615 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
11616 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
11617
11618 if (extra_trace_bits)
11619 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
11620
11621 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
11622 {
11623 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
11624 if (!user_settable_breakpoint (tp) || tp->number < 0)
11625 continue;
11626
11627 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
11628 if (filter && !filter (tp))
11629 continue;
11630
11631 if (tp->ops != NULL)
11632 (tp->ops->print_recreate) (tp, fp);
11633 else
11634 {
11635 if (tp->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
11636 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
11637 if (tp->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
11638 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
11639 else if (tp->type == bp_tracepoint)
11640 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
11641 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11642 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
11643 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
11644 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
11645 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
11646 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
11647 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
11648 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
11649 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
11650 else if (tp->type == bp_watchpoint)
11651 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11652 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
11653 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11654 else if (tp->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
11655 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11656 else if (tp->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
11657 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11658 else
11659 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11660 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
11661
11662 if (tp->exp_string)
11663 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->exp_string);
11664 else if (tp->addr_string)
11665 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
11666 else
11667 {
11668 char tmp[40];
11669
11670 sprintf_vma (tmp, tp->loc->address);
11671 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " *0x%s", tmp);
11672 }
11673 }
11674
11675 if (tp->thread != -1)
11676 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", tp->thread);
11677
11678 if (tp->task != 0)
11679 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", tp->task);
11680
11681 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
11682
11683 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
11684 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
11685 instead. */
11686
11687 if (tp->cond_string)
11688 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
11689
11690 if (tp->ignore_count)
11691 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
11692
11693 if (tp->pass_count)
11694 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
11695
11696 if (tp->commands)
11697 {
11698 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
11699
11700 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
11701
11702 ui_out_redirect (uiout, fp);
11703 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11704 {
11705 print_command_lines (uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
11706 }
11707 ui_out_redirect (uiout, NULL);
11708
11709 if (ex.reason < 0)
11710 throw_exception (ex);
11711
11712 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
11713 }
11714
11715 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
11716 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable\n");
11717
11718 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
11719 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
11720 special, and not user visible. */
11721 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
11722 {
11723 struct bp_location *loc;
11724 int n = 1;
11725
11726 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
11727 if (!loc->enabled)
11728 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
11729 }
11730 }
11731
11732 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
11733 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
11734
11735 do_cleanups (cleanup);
11736 if (from_tty)
11737 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
11738 }
11739
11740 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
11741
11742 static void
11743 save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11744 {
11745 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
11746 }
11747
11748 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
11749
11750 static void
11751 save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
11752 {
11753 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
11754 }
11755
11756 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
11757
11758 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
11759 all_tracepoints ()
11760 {
11761 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
11762 struct breakpoint *tp;
11763
11764 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
11765 {
11766 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
11767 }
11768
11769 return tp_vec;
11770 }
11771
11772 \f
11773 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
11774 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
11775 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
11776 command. */
11777 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
11778 command" [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
11779 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
11780 If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
11781 If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
11782 If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
11783 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
11784 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
11785 \n\
11786 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
11787 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
11788 \n\
11789 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
11790 conditions are different.\n\
11791 \n\
11792 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
11793
11794 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
11795 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
11796
11797 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
11798 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
11799
11800 /* Like add_cmd, but add the command to both the "catch" and "tcatch"
11801 lists, and pass some additional user data to the command function. */
11802 static void
11803 add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
11804 void (*sfunc) (char *args, int from_tty,
11805 struct cmd_list_element *command),
11806 char **(*completer) (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
11807 char *text, char *word),
11808 void *user_data_catch,
11809 void *user_data_tcatch)
11810 {
11811 struct cmd_list_element *command;
11812
11813 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
11814 &catch_cmdlist);
11815 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
11816 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
11817 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
11818
11819 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
11820 &tcatch_cmdlist);
11821 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
11822 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
11823 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
11824 }
11825
11826 static void
11827 clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
11828 {
11829 inf->total_syscalls_count = 0;
11830 inf->any_syscall_count = 0;
11831 VEC_free (int, inf->syscalls_counts);
11832 }
11833
11834 static void
11835 save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11836 {
11837 printf_unfiltered (_("\
11838 \"save\" must be followed by the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
11839 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", -1, gdb_stdout);
11840 }
11841
11842 struct breakpoint *
11843 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
11844 void *data)
11845 {
11846 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11847
11848 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11849 {
11850 if ((*callback) (b, data))
11851 return b;
11852 }
11853
11854 return NULL;
11855 }
11856
11857 void
11858 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
11859 {
11860 struct cmd_list_element *c;
11861
11862 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
11863 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
11864 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
11865
11866 breakpoint_chain = 0;
11867 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
11868 before a breakpoint is set. */
11869 breakpoint_count = 0;
11870
11871 tracepoint_count = 0;
11872
11873 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
11874 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
11875 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
11876 if (xdb_commands)
11877 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
11878
11879 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
11880 Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
11881 Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
11882 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
11883 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
11884 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
11885 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
11886 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
11887
11888 add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
11889 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
11890 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
11891 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
11892
11893 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
11894 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
11895 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
11896 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
11897 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
11898 \n"
11899 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
11900 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11901
11902 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
11903 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
11904 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
11905 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
11906 \n"
11907 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
11908 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11909
11910 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
11911 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
11912 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
11913 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
11914 \n"
11915 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
11916 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
11917
11918 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11919 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11920 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11921 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
11922 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11923 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
11924 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
11925 if (xdb_commands)
11926 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11927 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11928 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11929 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
11930 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11931 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
11932
11933 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11934
11935 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
11936 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
11937 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
11938 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
11939 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
11940 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
11941
11942 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
11943 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11944 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
11945 &enablebreaklist);
11946
11947 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
11948 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11949 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
11950 &enablebreaklist);
11951
11952 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
11953 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11954 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
11955 &enablelist);
11956
11957 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
11958 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
11959 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
11960 &enablelist);
11961
11962 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
11963 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11964 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11965 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11966 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."),
11967 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
11968 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11969 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
11970 if (xdb_commands)
11971 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
11972 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11973 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11974 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11975 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled."));
11976
11977 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
11978 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
11979 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11980 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11981 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until reenabled.\n\
11982 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
11983 &disablelist);
11984
11985 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
11986 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
11987 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11988 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
11989 \n\
11990 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
11991 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
11992 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
11993 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
11994 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
11995 if (xdb_commands)
11996 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
11997 Delete some breakpoints.\n\
11998 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
11999 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
12000
12001 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
12002 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
12003 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
12004 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
12005 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
12006 &deletelist);
12007
12008 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
12009 Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
12010 Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
12011 If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
12012 If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
12013 If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
12014 \n\
12015 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
12016 is executing in.\n\
12017 \n\
12018 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
12019 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
12020
12021 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
12022 Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
12023 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
12024 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12025
12026 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
12027 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
12028 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
12029 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
12030
12031 if (xdb_commands)
12032 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
12033
12034 if (dbx_commands)
12035 {
12036 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
12037 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
12038 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
12039 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
12040 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
12041 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
12042 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
12043 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
12044 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12045 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12046 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12047 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12048 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12049 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12050 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12051 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12052 \n\
12053 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12054 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12055 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12056 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12057 breakpoint set."));
12058 }
12059
12060 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
12061 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12062 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12063 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12064 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12065 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12066 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12067 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12068 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12069 \n\
12070 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12071 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12072 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12073 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12074 breakpoint set."));
12075
12076 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
12077
12078 if (xdb_commands)
12079 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
12080 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12081 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12082 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12083 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12084 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12085 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12086 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12087 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12088 \n\
12089 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12090 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12091 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12092 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12093 breakpoint set."));
12094
12095 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
12096 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
12097 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
12098 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
12099 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
12100 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
12101 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
12102 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
12103 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
12104 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
12105 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
12106 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
12107 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
12108 \n\
12109 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
12110 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
12111 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
12112 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
12113 breakpoint set."),
12114 &maintenanceinfolist);
12115
12116 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
12117 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
12118 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
12119 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12120
12121 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
12122 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
12123 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
12124 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12125
12126 /* Add catch and tcatch sub-commands. */
12127 add_catch_command ("catch", _("\
12128 Catch an exception, when caught.\n\
12129 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12130 catch_catch_command,
12131 NULL,
12132 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12133 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12134 add_catch_command ("throw", _("\
12135 Catch an exception, when thrown.\n\
12136 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12137 catch_throw_command,
12138 NULL,
12139 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12140 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12141 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
12142 catch_fork_command_1,
12143 NULL,
12144 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
12145 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
12146 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
12147 catch_fork_command_1,
12148 NULL,
12149 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
12150 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
12151 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
12152 catch_exec_command_1,
12153 NULL,
12154 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12155 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12156 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
12157 Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
12158 Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
12159 are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
12160 Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
12161 (if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
12162 catch_syscall_command_1,
12163 catch_syscall_completer,
12164 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12165 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12166 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
12167 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
12168 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12169 catch_ada_exception_command,
12170 NULL,
12171 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12172 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12173 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
12174 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
12175 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name."),
12176 catch_assert_command,
12177 NULL,
12178 CATCH_PERMANENT,
12179 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
12180
12181 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
12182 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12183 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12184 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12185 an expression changes.\n\
12186 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12187 the memory to which it refers."));
12188 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12189
12190 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
12191 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12192 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12193 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12194 an expression is read.\n\
12195 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12196 the memory to which it refers."));
12197 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12198
12199 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
12200 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
12201 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
12202 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
12203 an expression is either read or written.\n\
12204 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
12205 the memory to which it refers."));
12206 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
12207
12208 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
12209 Status of watchpoints, or watchpoint number NUMBER."));
12210
12211
12212
12213 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
12214 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
12215 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
12216 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
12217 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
12218 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
12219 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
12220 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
12221 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
12222 hardware.)"),
12223 NULL,
12224 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
12225 &setlist, &showlist);
12226
12227 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
12228
12229 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
12230
12231 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
12232 Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
12233 \n"
12234 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
12235 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12236 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12237
12238 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
12239 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12240 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12241 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
12242
12243 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
12244 Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
12245 \n"
12246 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
12247 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12248 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12249
12250 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
12251 Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
12252 \n\
12253 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
12254 LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
12255 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
12256 If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
12257 for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
12258 of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
12259 at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
12260 with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
12261 the selected stack frame.\n\
12262 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
12263 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
12264 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
12265 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
12266 \n\
12267 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
12268 \n\
12269 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
12270 conditions are different.\n\
12271 \n\
12272 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
12273 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
12274 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
12275
12276 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
12277 Status of tracepoints, or tracepoint number NUMBER.\n\
12278 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
12279 last tracepoint set."));
12280
12281 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
12282
12283 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
12284 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
12285 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12286 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
12287 &deletelist);
12288
12289 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
12290 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
12291 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12292 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
12293 &disablelist);
12294 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
12295
12296 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
12297 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
12298 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
12299 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
12300 &enablelist);
12301 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
12302
12303 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
12304 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
12305 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
12306 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
12307 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
12308
12309 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
12310 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
12311 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
12312 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
12313
12314 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
12315 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
12316 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
12317 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
12318 session to restore them."),
12319 &save_cmdlist);
12320 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
12321
12322 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
12323 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
12324 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
12325 &save_cmdlist);
12326 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
12327
12328 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
12329 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
12330
12331 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
12332 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
12333 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
12334 pending breakpoint behavior"),
12335 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
12336 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
12337 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
12338 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
12339 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
12340 pending breakpoint behavior"),
12341 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
12342 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
12343
12344 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
12345 &pending_break_support, _("\
12346 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
12347 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
12348 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
12349 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
12350 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
12351 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
12352 NULL,
12353 show_pending_break_support,
12354 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12355 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12356
12357 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
12358
12359 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
12360 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
12361 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
12362 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
12363 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
12364 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
12365 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
12366 NULL,
12367 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
12368 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12369 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12370
12371 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
12372 always_inserted_enums, &always_inserted_mode, _("\
12373 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12374 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
12375 When this mode is off, breakpoints are inserted in inferior when it is\n\
12376 resumed, and removed when execution stops. When this mode is on,\n\
12377 breakpoints are inserted immediately and removed only when the user\n\
12378 deletes the breakpoint. When this mode is auto (which is the default),\n\
12379 the behaviour depends on the non-stop setting (see help set non-stop).\n\
12380 In this case, if gdb is controlling the inferior in non-stop mode, gdb\n\
12381 behaves as if always-inserted mode is on; if gdb is controlling the\n\
12382 inferior in all-stop mode, gdb behaves as if always-inserted mode is off."),
12383 NULL,
12384 &show_always_inserted_mode,
12385 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
12386 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
12387
12388 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
12389
12390 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
12391 }
This page took 0.419221 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.